8641531944d69faaf2cdbfc916bd1c969f457cf4
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Daemon Configuration:: Daemon Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, ST STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and Intel Quark (x10xx)
160 based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 ST Micro has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with ST Micro chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @end itemize
491
492 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
493 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
494 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
495 @itemize @bullet
496 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
497 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
498 @end itemize
499
500 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
501 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
502 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
503 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
504
505 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
506 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
507 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
508
509 @section USB Other
510 @itemize @bullet
511 @item @b{USBprog}
512 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
513
514 @item @b{USB - Presto}
515 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
516
517 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
518 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
519
520 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
522
523 @item @b{Buspirate}
524 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
525
526 @item @b{opendous}
527 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
528
529 @item @b{estick}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
531
532 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
533 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
534 @end itemize
535
536 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
537
538 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
539 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
540 these on the market.
541
542 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
543 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
544 of USB-based ones.
545
546 @itemize @bullet
547
548 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
549 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
550
551 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
552 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
553 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
554
555 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
556 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
557
558 @item @b{Wiggler2}
559 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
560
561 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
562 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
563
564 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
565 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
566
567 @item @b{arm-jtag}
568 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
569
570 @item @b{chameleon}
571 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
572
573 @item @b{Triton}
574 @* Unknown.
575
576 @item @b{Lattice}
577 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
578 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
579
580 @item @b{flashlink}
581 @* From ST Microsystems;
582 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
583
584 @end itemize
585
586 @section Other...
587 @itemize @bullet
588
589 @item @b{ep93xx}
590 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
591
592 @item @b{at91rm9200}
593 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
594
595 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
596 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
597
598 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
599 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
600 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
601
602 @end itemize
603
604 @node About Jim-Tcl
605 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
606 @cindex Jim-Tcl
607 @cindex tcl
608
609 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
610 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
611 command interpreter.
612
613 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
614 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
615 much of anything about Tcl.
616 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
617
618 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
619 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
620 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
621 OpenOCD mailing list.
622
623 @itemize @bullet
624 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
625 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
626 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
627 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
628 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
629 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
630
631 @item @b{Missing Features}
632 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
633 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
634 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
635 enabled in OpenOCD.
636
637 @item @b{Scripts}
638 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
639 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
640 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
641
642 @item @b{Commands}
643 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
644 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
645 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
646 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
647
648 @item @b{Historical Note}
649 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
650 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
651 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
652 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
653
654 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
655 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
656 @end itemize
657
658 @node Running
659 @chapter Running
660 @cindex command line options
661 @cindex logfile
662 @cindex directory search
663
664 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
665 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
666 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
667 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
668 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
669 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
670 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
671
672 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
673 tell it how each debug session should work.
674 The @option{--help} option shows:
675 @verbatim
676 bash$ openocd --help
677
678 --help | -h display this help
679 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
680 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
681 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
682 --debug | -d set debug level <0-3>
683 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
684 --command | -c run <command>
685 @end verbatim
686
687 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
688 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
689 To specify one or more different
690 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
691
692 @example
693 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
694 @end example
695
696 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
697 @enumerate
698 @item the current directory,
699 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
700 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
701 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
702 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
703 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
704 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
705 @end enumerate
706 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
707
708 @quotation Note
709 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
710 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
711 @end quotation
712
713 @section Simple setup, no customization
714
715 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
716 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
717 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
718 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
719 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
720
721 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
722 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
723 the server with some variation of one of the following:
724
725 @example
726 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
727 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
728 @end example
729
730 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
731 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
732 If all goes well you'll see output something like
733
734 @example
735 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
736 For bug reports, read
737 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
738 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
739 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
740 @end example
741
742 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
743 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
744 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
745
746 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
747
748 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
749 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
750 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
751 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
752 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
753 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
754 ensure that this always succeeds.
755 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a daemon.
756 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
757 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
758 and then shut down without acting as a daemon.
759
760 Once OpenOCD starts running as a daemon, it waits for connections from
761 clients (Telnet, GDB, Other) and processes the commands issued through
762 those channels.
763
764 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
765 the @option{-d} option.
766
767 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
768 @option{-c} command line switch.
769
770 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
771 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
772 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
773 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
774 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
775 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
776 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
777
778 You can redirect all output from the daemon to a file using the
779 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
780
781 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
782 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
783 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
784 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
785
786 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
787 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
788
789 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
790 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
791 and start the OpenOCD server.
792 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
793 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
794 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
795 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
796
797 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
798
799 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
800 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
801 and a USB cable on the other.
802 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
803 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
804
805 @enumerate
806 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
807 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
808 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
809 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
810 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
811 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
812 debugging host.
813
814 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
815 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
816 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
817 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
818 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
819
820 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
821 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
822 with 1.2 Volt boards.
823
824 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
825 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
826 ways to connect the cable.
827 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
828 Be sure it's firmly connected.
829
830 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
831 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
832 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
833 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
834 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
835 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
836 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
837 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
838
839 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
840 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
841 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
842 but are tedious to set up.
843 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
844 adapter signals to the right board pins.
845
846 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
847 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
848 you are using to run OpenOCD.
849 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
850
851 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
852 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
853 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
854 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
855
856 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
857 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
858 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
859
860 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
861 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
862 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
863 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
864
865 @end enumerate
866
867 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
868 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
869 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
870
871 @section Project Directory
872
873 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
874
875 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
876 single directory for your work with a given board.
877 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
878 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
879 files accessed through semihosting,
880 and for code you upload to the target board.
881 It is also the natural place to write files,
882 such as log files and data you download from the board.
883
884 @section Configuration Basics
885
886 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
887 a variety of ways you can mix them.
888 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
889
890 @itemize
891 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
892 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
893 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
894 @end itemize
895
896 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
897 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
898 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
899
900 @example
901 source [find interface/signalyzer.cfg]
902
903 # GDB can also flash my flash!
904 gdb_memory_map enable
905 gdb_flash_program enable
906
907 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
908 @end example
909
910 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
911
912 @example
913 openocd -f interface/signalyzer.cfg \
914 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
915 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
916 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
917 @end example
918
919 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
920 each supporting a different development task.
921 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
922 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
923
924 @quotation Important
925 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
926 problems with how it treats variables.
927 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
928 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
929 that can be tested in a later script.
930 @end quotation
931
932 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
933 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
934 to simplify your work.
935
936 @section User Config Files
937 @cindex config file, user
938 @cindex user config file
939 @cindex config file, overview
940
941 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
942 in one place.
943 One of the following will match your situation best:
944
945 @itemize
946 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
947 provided by someone else.
948 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
949 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
950 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
951 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
952 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
953 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
954
955 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
956 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
957
958 @enumerate
959 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
960 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
961 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
962 @end enumerate
963
964 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
965 The first is an interface config file.
966 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
967 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
968 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
969 meet your deadline:
970
971 @example
972 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
973 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
974 @end example
975
976 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
977 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
978 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
979 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
980
981 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
982 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
983 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
984 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
985 target and board
986 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
987 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
988
989 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
990 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
991 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
992 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
993
994 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
995 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
996 giving access to your particular flash chips.
997 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
998 for a new chip built around the Cortex M3 core.
999
1000 @quotation Note
1001 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1002 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1003 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1004 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1005 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1006 @end quotation
1007
1008 @item
1009 You may may need to write some C code.
1010 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1011 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1012 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1013 a new chip architecture.
1014 @end itemize
1015
1016 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1017 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1018 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1019
1020 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1021 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1022 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1023 @itemize
1024
1025 @item
1026 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1027 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1028 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1029 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1030
1031 @item
1032 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1033 @cindex vector_catch
1034 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1035 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a timesaver
1036 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1037 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1038 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1039 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1040
1041 @item
1042 You might need to override some defaults.
1043 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1044 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1045
1046 @item
1047 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1048 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1049 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1050 @end itemize
1051
1052 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1053
1054 A few project-specific utility
1055 routines may well speed up your work.
1056 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1057
1058 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1059 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1060 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1061 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1062 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1063 may help:
1064
1065 @example
1066 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1067 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1068 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1069 # Leave the CPU halted.
1070 reset init
1071
1072 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1073 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1074
1075 # Start running.
1076 resume 0x20000000
1077 @}
1078 @end example
1079
1080 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1081 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1082 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1083 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1084 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1085
1086 @example
1087 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1088 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1089 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1090 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1091 reset init
1092
1093 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1094 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1095 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1096 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1097 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1098 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1099 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1100
1101 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1102 reset run
1103 @}
1104 @end example
1105
1106 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1107 from NAND.
1108 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1109 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1110 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1111
1112 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1113 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1114
1115 @section Target Software Changes
1116
1117 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1118 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1119 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1120 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1121 handling issues like:
1122
1123 @itemize @bullet
1124
1125 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1126 Watchog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1127 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1128 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1129 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1130 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1131 your debug sessions.
1132
1133 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1134 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1135 That might however be your only option.
1136
1137 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1138 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1139 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1140 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1141 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1142 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1143 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1144 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1145 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1146 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1147 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1148 instead of the whole thing.
1149 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1150 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1151
1152 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1153 @cindex ARM semihosting
1154 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1155 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1156 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1157 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1158 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1159 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1160 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1161 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1162 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1163 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1164 NAND or SPI flash.
1165
1166 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1167 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1168 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1169 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1170 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1171
1172 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1173 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1174 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1175 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1176 registers which can be used to change various features including
1177 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1178 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1179 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1180 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1181 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1182
1183 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1184 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1185 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1186 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1187 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1188
1189 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1190 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1191 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1192 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1193 early code execution can be debugged
1194 or firmware can be replaced.
1195
1196 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1197 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1198 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1199 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1200 operations like writing to memory.)
1201
1202 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1203 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1204 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1205 various kinds of message.
1206 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1207
1208 @end itemize
1209
1210 @section Target Hardware Setup
1211
1212 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1213 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1214 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1215 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1216 working with.}
1217
1218 Common issues include:
1219
1220 @itemize @bullet
1221
1222 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1223 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1224 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1225 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1226 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1227 or one from a daughtercard).
1228 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1229 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1230
1231 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1232 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1233 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1234 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1235 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1236 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1237
1238 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1239 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1240 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1241 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1242 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1243
1244
1245 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1246 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1247 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1248 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1249 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1250 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1251 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1252
1253 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1254 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1255 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1256 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1257 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1258
1259 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1260 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1261 used to start booting.
1262
1263 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1264 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1265 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1266 multiple audio codec chips).
1267 This interacts with software
1268 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1269 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1270 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1271 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1272 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1273 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1274 audio or video codecs are used.
1275
1276 @end itemize
1277
1278 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1279 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1280 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1281 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1282 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1283 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1284 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1285 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1286 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1287 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1288
1289
1290 @node Config File Guidelines
1291 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1292
1293 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1294 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1295 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1296 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1297
1298 You should find the following directories under
1299 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1300 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1301 @itemize @bullet
1302 @item @file{interface} ...
1303 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1304 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1305 @item @file{board} ...
1306 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1307 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1308
1309 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1310 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1311 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1312 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1313 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1314 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1315 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1316 a CPU and an FPGA.
1317 @item @file{target} ...
1318 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1319 on a chip
1320 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1321 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1322 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1323 the target config file defines all of them.
1324 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1325 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1326 @end itemize
1327
1328 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1329 file may override features in any of the above files by
1330 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1331 commands specific to their situation.
1332
1333 @section Interface Config Files
1334
1335 The user config file
1336 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1337
1338 @example
1339 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1340 @end example
1341
1342 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1343 in use today with OpenOCD.
1344 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1345 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1346
1347 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1348 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1349 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1350 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1351 and need to provide a driver for it.
1352
1353 @section Board Config Files
1354 @cindex config file, board
1355 @cindex board config file
1356
1357 The user config file
1358 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1359
1360 @example
1361 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1362 @end example
1363
1364 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1365 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1366 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1367
1368 @enumerate
1369 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1370 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1371 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1372 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1373 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1374 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1375 @end enumerate
1376
1377 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1378 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1379 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1380 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1381
1382 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1383 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1384 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1385 configuration works.
1386
1387 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1388
1389 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1390 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1391 convention on how to use certain variables.
1392
1393 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1394 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1395 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1396 used at will within a target configuration file.
1397
1398 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1399 for a board with three chips:
1400
1401 @example
1402 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1403 set CHIPNAME network
1404 set ENDIAN big
1405 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1406 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1407 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1408 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1409
1410 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1411 set CHIPNAME video
1412 set ENDIAN little
1413 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1414 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1415 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1416 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1417
1418 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1419 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1420 unset ENDIAN
1421 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1422 @end example
1423
1424 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1425 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1426 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1427 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1428 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1429 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1430 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1431 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1432
1433 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1434 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1435 naming collisions.
1436
1437 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1438 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1439 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1440 up other clocks and peripherals.
1441
1442 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1443 @cindex variable names
1444
1445 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1446 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1447 one such chip (as shown above).
1448 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1449 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1450 to promote consistency and
1451 so that board files can override target defaults.
1452
1453 Inputs to target config files include:
1454
1455 @itemize @bullet
1456 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1457 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1458 tap identifier dotted names.
1459 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1460 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1461 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1462 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1463 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1464 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1465 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1466 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1467 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1468 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1469 @end itemize
1470
1471 Outputs from target config files include:
1472
1473 @itemize @bullet
1474 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1475 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1476 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1477 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1478 specific to that board and that target.
1479 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1480 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1481 @end itemize
1482
1483 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1484 @cindex event, reset-init
1485 @cindex reset-init handler
1486
1487 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1488 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1489 fully set up yet.
1490 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1491 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1492 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1493 handler is one of the most important.
1494
1495 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1496 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1497 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1498 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1499 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1500
1501 @quotation Note
1502 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1503 are included here.
1504 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1505 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1506 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1507 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1508 @end quotation
1509
1510 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1511 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1512 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1513 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1514 those as parameters.
1515 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1516 and disabling the watchdog.
1517 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1518 the next developer doing such work.
1519 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1520
1521 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1522 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1523 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1524 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1525
1526 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1527
1528 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1529 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1530 a low JTAG clock rate.
1531 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1532 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1533 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1534 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1535 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1536 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1537 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1538
1539 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1540 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1541 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1542 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1543 which might be less than that.
1544
1545 @quotation Warning
1546 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1547 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1548 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1549 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1550 @end quotation
1551
1552 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1553 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1554 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1555 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1556 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1557 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1558
1559 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1560 @subsection The init_board procedure
1561 @cindex init_board procedure
1562
1563 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1564 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1565 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1566 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1567 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1568 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1569 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1570 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1571 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1572 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1573 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1574 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1575
1576 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1577 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1578
1579 @example
1580 ### board_file.cfg ###
1581
1582 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1583 source [find target/target.cfg]
1584
1585 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1586 # enables fast on-board clock source
1587 # configures the chip to use it
1588 @}
1589
1590 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1591 proc init_board @{@} @{
1592 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1593
1594 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1595 adapter_khz 1
1596 enable_fast_clock
1597 adapter_khz 10000
1598 @}
1599 @}
1600 @end example
1601
1602 @section Target Config Files
1603 @cindex config file, target
1604 @cindex target config file
1605
1606 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1607 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1608 more target config files like this:
1609
1610 @example
1611 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1612 @end example
1613
1614 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1615 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1616 In summary the target files should contain
1617
1618 @enumerate
1619 @item Set defaults
1620 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1621 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1622 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1623 @item On-Chip flash
1624 @end enumerate
1625
1626 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1627 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1628 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1629
1630 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1631 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1632 can talk to the chip.
1633 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1634 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1635 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1636 and other processing engines.
1637
1638 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1639
1640 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1641 letting board config files express environment-specific
1642 differences in how things should be set up.
1643
1644 @example
1645 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1646 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1647 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1648 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1649 @} else @{
1650 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1651 @}
1652
1653 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1654 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1655 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1656 @} else @{
1657 set _ENDIAN little
1658 @}
1659
1660 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1661 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1662 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1663 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1664 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1665 @} else @{
1666 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1667 @}
1668 @end example
1669 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1670
1671 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1672 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1673 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1674
1675 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1676 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1677 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1678
1679 @example
1680 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1681 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1682 @end example
1683
1684 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1685 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1686 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1687 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1688 for taps.
1689
1690 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1691 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1692 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1693 looks (in part) like this:
1694
1695 @example
1696 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1697 @end example
1698
1699 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1700 to source such a config file twice, with different
1701 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1702 it adds a different TAP each time.
1703
1704 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1705 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1706 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1707 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1708
1709 @example
1710 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1711 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1712 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1713 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1714 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1715 @end example
1716
1717 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1718 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1719
1720 @itemize
1721 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1722 plus a JRC to enable them
1723 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1724 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1725 is not currently used)
1726 @end itemize
1727
1728 @subsection Add CPU targets
1729
1730 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1731 GDB and other commands can use it.
1732 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1733 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1734 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1735 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1736
1737 @example
1738 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1739 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1740 @end example
1741
1742 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1743 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1744 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1745 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1746 a work area if you can.
1747 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1748
1749 @example
1750 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1751 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1752 @end example
1753
1754 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1755 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1756 @cindex SMP
1757 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1758
1759 @example
1760 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1761 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1762 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1763 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1764 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1765 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1766 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1767 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1768 @end example
1769 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1770 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1771 @itemize @bullet
1772 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1773 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1774 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1775 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1776 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1777 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1778 @end itemize
1779
1780 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1781 command have been implemented.
1782 @itemize @bullet
1783 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1784 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1785 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1786 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1787 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1788 following example.
1789 @end itemize
1790
1791 @example
1792 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1793 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1794 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1795 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1796 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1797 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1798 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1799 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1800 > resume
1801 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1802 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1803 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1804 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1805 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1806 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1807 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1808 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 @end example
1810
1811
1812 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1813
1814 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1815 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1816 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1817
1818 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1819 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1820 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1821 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1822 both signals.
1823
1824 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1825 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1826 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1827 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1828 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1829 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1830 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1831 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1832 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1833 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1834 not available.)
1835
1836 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1837 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1838 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1839 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1840 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1841 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1842 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1843 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1844
1845 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1846 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1847 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1848 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1849 slower clock than they will use later.
1850 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1851 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1852 than they will use later.
1853 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1854
1855 @quotation Important
1856 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1857 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1858 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1859 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1860 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1861 @end quotation
1862
1863 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1864 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1865 @cindex init_targets procedure
1866
1867 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1868 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1869 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1870 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1871 Such procedure can be overriden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1872 This concept faciliates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1873 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enchanced or changed in
1874 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1875 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1876
1877 @example
1878 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1879
1880 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1881 # basic initialization procedure ...
1882 @}
1883
1884 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1885 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1886 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1887 @}
1888
1889 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1890
1891 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1892
1893 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1894 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1895 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1896 @}
1897 @end example
1898
1899 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1900 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1901
1902 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1903
1904 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1905 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1906
1907 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1908 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1909 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1910
1911 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1912 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1913 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1914 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1915 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1916 events already assigned.
1917
1918 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1919
1920 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1921 special high speed download features - enable it.
1922
1923 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1924
1925 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1926 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1927 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1928 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1929 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1930 If you are using an external trace port,
1931 configure it in your board config file.
1932 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1933 configure it in your target config file.
1934
1935 @example
1936 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1937 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1938 @end example
1939
1940 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1941
1942 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1943
1944 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1945 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1946 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1947 the TARGET (chip) file.
1948
1949 Examples:
1950 @itemize @bullet
1951 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1952 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1953 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1954 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1955 @end itemize
1956
1957 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1958 @section Translating Configuration Files
1959 @cindex translation
1960 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1961 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1962 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1963 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1964 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1965 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1966
1967 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1968 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1969 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1970 convert other scripts later on.
1971
1972 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1973 replace job:
1974
1975 @example
1976 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1977 #
1978 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1979 #
1980 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1981 #
1982 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1983
1984 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1985 global TARGETNAME
1986
1987 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
1988
1989 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
1990 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
1991 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
1992 @}
1993 @end example
1994
1995
1996
1997 @node Daemon Configuration
1998 @chapter Daemon Configuration
1999 @cindex initialization
2000 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2001 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2002 supported.
2003
2004 @anchor{configurationstage}
2005 @section Configuration Stage
2006 @cindex configuration stage
2007 @cindex config command
2008
2009 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2010 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2011 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2012 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2013 inside startup scripts.
2014
2015 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2016 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2017 which may be issued interactively.
2018 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2019 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2020
2021 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2022 flash banks,
2023 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2024 and other basic setup.
2025 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2026 may access or activate TAPs.
2027 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2028 longer be issued.
2029
2030 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2031 @section Entering the Run Stage
2032
2033 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2034 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2035 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2036 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2037 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2038 You should see no errors at this point.
2039 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2040 commands you used to configure the server.
2041 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2042 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2043 on the scan chain.
2044
2045 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2046 become available.
2047 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2048 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2049 a target has been successfuly instantiated.
2050 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2051 entry to the run stage.
2052
2053 @deffn {Config Command} init
2054 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2055 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2056 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2057 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2058 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2059 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2060
2061 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2062 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2063 configuration files and/or command line options.
2064
2065 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2066 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2067 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2068 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2069 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2070 @end deffn
2071
2072 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2073 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2074 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2075
2076 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2077 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2078 scan chain.
2079 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2080 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2081
2082 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2083 they return.
2084 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2085 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2086 @end deffn
2087
2088 @anchor{tcpipports}
2089 @section TCP/IP Ports
2090 @cindex TCP port
2091 @cindex server
2092 @cindex port
2093 @cindex security
2094 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2095 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2096 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2097
2098 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2099 access using one or more of these ports.
2100 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as zero.
2101 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2102 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2103
2104 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2105 @cindex GDB server
2106 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2107 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2108 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2109 the normal use cases.
2110
2111 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2112 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disable"
2113 disables the gdb server.
2114
2115 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2116 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2117
2118 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2119 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2120
2121 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2122 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2123 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2124
2125 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2126 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2127 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2128 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2129
2130 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2131 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2132 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2133
2134 @end deffn
2135
2136 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2137 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2138 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2139 output from the Tcl engine.
2140 Intended as a machine interface.
2141 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2142 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2143
2144 @end deffn
2145
2146 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2147 Specify or query the
2148 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2149 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2150 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2151 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2152 When specified as zero, this port is not activated.
2153 @end deffn
2154
2155 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2156 @section GDB Configuration
2157 @cindex GDB
2158 @cindex GDB configuration
2159 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2160 The ones listed here are static and global.
2161 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2162 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2163
2164 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2165 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2166 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2167 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2168 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2169 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2170 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2171 @end deffn
2172
2173 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2174 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2175 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2176 vFlash packet is received.
2177 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2178 @end deffn
2179
2180 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2181 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2182 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2183 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2184 for flash programming to work.
2185 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2186 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2187 @end deffn
2188
2189 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2190 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2191 by GDB memory read packets.
2192 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2193 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2194 @end deffn
2195
2196 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2197 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2198 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2199 @end deffn
2200
2201 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2202 Saves the target descripton file to the local file system.
2203
2204 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2205 @end deffn
2206
2207 @anchor{eventpolling}
2208 @section Event Polling
2209
2210 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2211 where significant events can happen at any time.
2212 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2213 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2214 or to GDB.
2215
2216 Examples of such events include:
2217
2218 @itemize
2219 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2220 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2221 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2222 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2223 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2224 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2225 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2226 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2227 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2228 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2229 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2230 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2231 @end itemize
2232
2233 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2234 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2235 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2236 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2237 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2238
2239 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2240 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2241 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2242 to the various active targets.
2243 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2244 which is normally done in the background.
2245
2246 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2247 Poll the current target for its current state.
2248 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2249 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2250 specific information about the current state is printed.
2251 An optional parameter
2252 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2253
2254 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2255 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2256 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2257 @example
2258 > poll
2259 background polling: on
2260 target state: halted
2261 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2262 current mode: Supervisor
2263 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2264 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2265 >
2266 @end example
2267 @end deffn
2268
2269 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2270 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2271 @cindex config file, interface
2272 @cindex interface config file
2273
2274 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2275 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2276 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2277
2278 @quotation Note
2279 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2280 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2281 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2282 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2283 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2284 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2285 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2286 @end quotation
2287
2288 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2289 through commands in an interface configuration
2290 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2291 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2292
2293 @example
2294 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2295 @end example
2296
2297 These commands tell
2298 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2299 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2300
2301 @example
2302 # jlink interface
2303 interface jlink
2304 @end example
2305
2306 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2307
2308
2309 @section Interface Configuration
2310
2311 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2312 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2313 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2314
2315 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2316 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2317 target.
2318 @end deffn
2319
2320 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2321 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2322 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2323 @end deffn
2324 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2325 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2326 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2327 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2328 the hardware can support.
2329 @end deffn
2330
2331
2332
2333 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2334 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2335 @end deffn
2336
2337 @section Interface Drivers
2338
2339 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2340 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2341 available at run time.
2342
2343 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2344 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2345 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2346 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2347
2348 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2349 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2350 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2354 Displays status of RTCK option.
2355 Optionally sets that option first.
2356 @end deffn
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2360 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2361 This has one driver-specific command:
2362
2363 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2364 Logs some status
2365 @end deffn
2366 @end deffn
2367
2368 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2369 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2370 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2371 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2372 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2373 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2374 @end deffn
2375
2376 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2377 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2378
2379 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2380 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2381 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2382 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2383 @example
2384 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2385 @end example
2386 @end deffn
2387
2388 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2389 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2390 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2391 @end deffn
2392
2393 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2394 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2395 @end deffn
2396 @end deffn
2397
2398 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2399 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2400 @end deffn
2401
2402 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2403 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2404 @end deffn
2405
2406 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft2232}
2407 FTDI FT2232 (USB) based devices over one of the userspace libraries.
2408
2409 Note that this driver has several flaws and the @command{ftdi} driver is
2410 recommended as its replacement.
2411
2412 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2413 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2414
2415 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_device_desc} description
2416 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2417 of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not
2418 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2419 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2420 @end deffn
2421
2422 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_serial} serial-number
2423 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the FTDI FT2232 device to use,
2424 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one FT2232 device
2425 is connected to the host.
2426 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2427 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2428 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2429 @end deffn
2430
2431 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_layout} name
2432 Each vendor's FT2232 device can use different GPIO signals
2433 to control output-enables, reset signals, and LEDs.
2434 Currently valid layout @var{name} values include:
2435 @itemize @minus
2436 @item @b{axm0432_jtag} Axiom AXM-0432
2437 @item @b{comstick} Hitex STR9 comstick
2438 @item @b{cortino} Hitex Cortino JTAG interface
2439 @item @b{evb_lm3s811} TI/Luminary Micro EVB_LM3S811 as a JTAG interface,
2440 either for the local Cortex-M3 (SRST only)
2441 or in a passthrough mode (neither SRST nor TRST)
2442 This layout can not support the SWO trace mechanism, and should be
2443 used only for older boards (before rev C).
2444 @item @b{luminary_icdi} This layout should be used with most TI/Luminary
2445 eval boards, including Rev C LM3S811 eval boards and the eponymous
2446 ICDI boards, to debug either the local Cortex-M3 or in passthrough mode
2447 to debug some other target. It can support the SWO trace mechanism.
2448 @item @b{flyswatter} Tin Can Tools Flyswatter
2449 @item @b{icebear} ICEbear JTAG adapter from Section 5
2450 @item @b{jtagkey} Amontec JTAGkey and JTAGkey-Tiny (and compatibles)
2451 @item @b{jtagkey2} Amontec JTAGkey2 (and compatibles)
2452 @item @b{m5960} American Microsystems M5960
2453 @item @b{olimex-jtag} Olimex ARM-USB-OCD and ARM-USB-Tiny
2454 @item @b{oocdlink} OOCDLink
2455 @c oocdlink ~= jtagkey_prototype_v1
2456 @item @b{redbee-econotag} Integrated with a Redbee development board.
2457 @item @b{redbee-usb} Integrated with a Redbee USB-stick development board.
2458 @item @b{sheevaplug} Marvell Sheevaplug development kit
2459 @item @b{signalyzer} Xverve Signalyzer
2460 @item @b{stm32stick} Hitex STM32 Performance Stick
2461 @item @b{turtelizer2} egnite Software turtelizer2
2462 @item @b{usbjtag} "USBJTAG-1" layout described in the OpenOCD diploma thesis
2463 @end itemize
2464 @end deffn
2465
2466 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2467 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not specified, the FTDI
2468 default values are used.
2469 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2470 @example
2471 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2472 @end example
2473 @end deffn
2474
2475 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_latency} ms
2476 On some systems using FT2232 based JTAG interfaces the FT_Read function call in
2477 ft2232_read() fails to return the expected number of bytes. This can be caused by
2478 USB communication delays and has proved hard to reproduce and debug. Setting the
2479 FT2232 latency timer to a larger value increases delays for short USB packets but it
2480 also reduces the risk of timeouts before receiving the expected number of bytes.
2481 The OpenOCD default value is 2 and for some systems a value of 10 has proved useful.
2482 @end deffn
2483
2484 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_channel} channel
2485 Used to select the channel of the ft2232 chip to use (between 1 and 4).
2486 The default value is 1.
2487 @end deffn
2488
2489 For example, the interface config file for a
2490 Turtelizer JTAG Adapter looks something like this:
2491
2492 @example
2493 interface ft2232
2494 ft2232_device_desc "Turtelizer JTAG/RS232 Adapter"
2495 ft2232_layout turtelizer2
2496 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xbdc8
2497 @end example
2498 @end deffn
2499
2500 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2501 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2502 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2503 It is a complete rewrite to address a large number of problems with the ft2232
2504 interface driver.
2505
2506 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2507 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi of D2XX. Performance-wise it is
2508 consistently faster than the ft2232 driver, sometimes several times faster.
2509
2510 A major improvement of this driver is that support for new FTDI based adapters
2511 can be added competely through configuration files, without the need to patch
2512 and rebuild OpenOCD.
2513
2514 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2515 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2516 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2517 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2518 will be used for their customary purpose.
2519
2520 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2521 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2522 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2523 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2524
2525 @itemize @minus
2526 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2527 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2528 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2529 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2530 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2531 switching data and direction as necessary
2532 @end itemize
2533
2534 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2535 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2536
2537 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2538 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, the FTDI
2539 default values are used.
2540 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2541 @example
2542 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2543 @end example
2544 @end deffn
2545
2546 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2547 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2548 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2549 during device selection.
2550 @end deffn
2551
2552 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2553 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2554 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2555 is connected to the host.
2556 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2557 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2558 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2559 @end deffn
2560
2561 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2562 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2563 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2564 @end deffn
2565
2566 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2567 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2568 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2569 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2570 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2571 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2572 and initially asserted reset signals.
2573 @end deffn
2574
2575 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2576 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2577 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2578 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2579 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2580 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2581 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2582 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2583 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected.
2584
2585 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2586 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2587 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2588 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2589 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2590 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2591
2592 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2593 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2594 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2595 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2596 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2597 are always driven by the FTDI.
2598
2599 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2600 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2601 @var{name}.
2602 @end deffn
2603
2604 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2605 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2606 @itemize @minus
2607 @item @option{0}, drive low
2608 @item @option{1}, drive high
2609 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2610 @end itemize
2611 @end deffn
2612
2613 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2614 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2615 @end deffn
2616
2617 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2618 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2619 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2620 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2621
2622 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2623 processors which are being simulated.
2624
2625 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2626 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2627 sockets instead of TCP.
2628 @end deffn
2629
2630 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2631 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2632 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2633 @end deffn
2634
2635 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2636 something like:
2637
2638 @example
2639 interface remote_bitbang
2640 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2641 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2642 @end example
2643
2644 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2645 named mysocket:
2646
2647 @example
2648 interface remote_bitbang
2649 remote_bitbang_port 0
2650 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2651 @end example
2652 @end deffn
2653
2654 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2655 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2656 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2657 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2658
2659 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2660 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2661 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2662 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2663 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2664 @end deffn
2665
2666 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2667 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2668 default values are used.
2669 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2670 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2671 @example
2672 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2673 @end example
2674 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2675 @example
2676 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2677 @end example
2678 @end deffn
2679
2680 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2681 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2682 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2683 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2684 target board.
2685
2686 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2687 @example
2688 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2689 reset_config srst_only
2690 @end example
2691 @end deffn
2692
2693 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ftd2xx}|@option{ublast2})
2694 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2695 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2696 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2697 @end deffn
2698
2699 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2700 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2701 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2702 @end deffn
2703
2704 @end deffn
2705
2706 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2707 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2708 This has one driver-specific command:
2709
2710 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2711 Display either the address of the I/O port
2712 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2713 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2714 This is a write-once setting.
2715 @end deffn
2716 @end deffn
2717
2718 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2719 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2720 transports.
2721
2722 @quotation Compatibility Note
2723 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many harware versions they
2724 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2725 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2726 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2727 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2728 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2729 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2730 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2731 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2732 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2733 @end quotation
2734
2735 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2736 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2737 states.
2738 @end deffn
2739 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2740 Display free device internal memory.
2741 @end deffn
2742 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2743 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2744 command version.
2745 @end deffn
2746 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2747 Display the device configuration.
2748 @end deffn
2749 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2750 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2751 power state.
2752 @end deffn
2753 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2754 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2755 @end deffn
2756 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2757 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2758 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2759 IP configuration.
2760 @end deffn
2761 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2762 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2763 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2764 @end deffn
2765 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2766 Reset the current configuration.
2767 @end deffn
2768 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2769 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2770 @end deffn
2771 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2772 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2773 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2774 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2775 instead.
2776
2777 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2778 @end deffn
2779 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2780 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2781 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2782
2783 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2784 @end deffn
2785 @end deffn
2786
2787 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2788 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2789 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2790 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2791 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2792
2793 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2794 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2795 This is a write-once setting.
2796 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2797
2798 @itemize @minus
2799 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2800 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2801 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2802 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2803 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2804 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2805 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2806 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2807 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2808 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2809 some versions of
2810 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2811 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2812 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2813 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2814 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2815 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2816 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2817 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2818 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2819 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2820 @end itemize
2821 @end deffn
2822
2823 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2824 Display either the address of the I/O port
2825 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2826 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2827 This is a write-once setting.
2828
2829 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2830 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2831 you may encounter a problem.
2832 @end deffn
2833
2834 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2835 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2836 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2837 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2838 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2839 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2840
2841 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2842 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2843 @quotation Tip
2844 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2845 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2846 @example
2847 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2848 > adapter_khz 500
2849 @end example
2850 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2851 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2852 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2853 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2854 large set of samples.
2855 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2856 @example
2857 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2858 @end example
2859 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
2860 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2861
2862 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2863 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2864 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2865 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2866 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
2867 @end quotation
2868 @end deffn
2869
2870 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
2871 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
2872 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
2873 @end deffn
2874
2875 For example, the interface configuration file for a
2876 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
2877
2878 @example
2879 interface parport
2880 parport_port 0x278
2881 parport_cable wiggler
2882 @end example
2883 @end deffn
2884
2885 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
2886 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
2887 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
2888 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
2889 @end deffn
2890 @end deffn
2891
2892 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
2893 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
2894 @end deffn
2895
2896 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
2897 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2898 @end deffn
2899
2900 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
2901 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
2902
2903 @quotation Note
2904 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
2905 which are not currently documented here.
2906 @end quotation
2907 @end deffn
2908
2909 @anchor{hla_interface}
2910 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
2911 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
2912 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
2913 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
2914
2915 Currently supported adapters include the ST STLINK and TI ICDI.
2916 STLINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
2917 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
2918 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade STLINK firmware even if current
2919 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
2920
2921 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
2922 Currently Not Supported.
2923 @end deffn
2924
2925 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
2926 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
2927 @end deffn
2928
2929 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
2930 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
2931 @end deffn
2932
2933 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} vid pid
2934 The vendor ID and product ID of the device.
2935 @end deffn
2936
2937 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
2938 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
2939 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
2940 @end deffn
2941 @end deffn
2942
2943 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
2944 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2945 @end deffn
2946
2947 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
2948 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
2949 @end deffn
2950
2951 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
2952 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
2953 @end deffn
2954
2955 @quotation Note
2956 This defines some driver-specific commands,
2957 which are not currently documented here.
2958 @end quotation
2959
2960 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2961 Turn power switch to target on/off.
2962 No arguments: print status.
2963 @end deffn
2964
2965 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
2966 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
2967 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
2968
2969 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
2970 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
2971 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
2972 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
2973 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
2974 configuration on exit.
2975
2976 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
2977 pinout.
2978
2979 @end deffn
2980
2981 @section Transport Configuration
2982 @cindex Transport
2983 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
2984 and the debug adapter you are using,
2985 several transports may be available to
2986 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
2987 @deffn Command {transport list}
2988 displays the names of the transports supported by this
2989 version of OpenOCD.
2990 @end deffn
2991
2992 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
2993 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
2994
2995 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
2996 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
2997 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
2998 adapter's driver).
2999
3000 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3001 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3002 supported by the debug adapter.
3003
3004 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3005 transport, if any.
3006 @end deffn
3007
3008 @subsection JTAG Transport
3009 @cindex JTAG
3010 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3011 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3012 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3013 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3014 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3015 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3016
3017 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3018 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3019 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3020 hla_jtag}.
3021
3022 @subsection SWD Transport
3023 @cindex SWD
3024 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3025 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3026 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3027 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3028 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3029 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3030 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3031
3032 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3033 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3034 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3035 hla_swd}.
3036
3037 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3038 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3039 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3040 expected to change.
3041 @end deffn
3042 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3043 Updates TRN (turnaraound delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3044 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3045 No parameters: displays current settings.
3046 @end deffn
3047
3048 @subsection SPI Transport
3049 @cindex SPI
3050 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3051 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3052 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3053 solution for flash programming.
3054
3055 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3056 @section JTAG Speed
3057 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3058 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3059 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3060 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3061 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3062 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3063 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3064 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3065 power management software that may be active.
3066
3067 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3068 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3069 target event handler.
3070 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3071 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3072 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3073 sets up those clocks).
3074 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3075 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3076 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3077 in the target config file.
3078 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3079 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3080 config file instead.
3081 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3082 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3083 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3084
3085 @example
3086 jtag_rclk 3000
3087 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3088 @end example
3089
3090 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3091 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3092 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3093 may not be the fastest solution.
3094
3095 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3096 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3097 which support adaptive clocking.
3098
3099 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3100 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3101 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3102 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3103 than the speed specified.
3104
3105 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3106 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3107 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3108 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3109
3110 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3111 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3112 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3113 JTAG clocking after setup.
3114 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3115 If the interface device can not
3116 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3117 @end deffn
3118
3119 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3120 @cindex adaptive clocking
3121 @cindex RTCK
3122 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3123 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3124 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3125 @example
3126 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3127 jtag_rclk 3000
3128 @end example
3129 @end defun
3130
3131 @node Reset Configuration
3132 @chapter Reset Configuration
3133 @cindex Reset Configuration
3134
3135 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3136 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3137 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3138 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3139 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3140 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3141 Please see the various board files for examples.
3142
3143 @quotation Note
3144 To maintainers and integrators:
3145 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3146 Normally the board configuration file
3147 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3148 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3149
3150 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3151 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3152 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3153 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3154 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3155 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3156 @end quotation
3157
3158 @section Types of Reset
3159
3160 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3161 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3162 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3163
3164 @itemize @bullet
3165 @item
3166 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3167 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3168 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3169 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3170 @item
3171 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3172 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3173 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3174 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3175 @item
3176 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3177 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3178 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3179 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3180 @item
3181 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3182 several other types of reset.
3183 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3184 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3185 There may be individual module resets.
3186 @end itemize
3187
3188 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3189 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3190 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3191 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3192 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3193 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3194 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3195 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3196 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3197
3198 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3199 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3200
3201 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3202 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3203 common issues are:
3204
3205 @itemize @bullet
3206
3207 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3208 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3209 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3210 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3211 when either of those signals is not connected.
3212 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3213 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3214 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3215 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3216
3217 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3218 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3219 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3220 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3221
3222 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3223 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3224 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3225 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3226 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3227 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3228 hardware debouncing.
3229 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3230 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3231
3232 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3233 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3234 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3235 to use push/pull output drivers.
3236 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3237 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3238 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3239 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3240
3241 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3242 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3243 issues (not limited to errata).
3244 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3245 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3246 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3247 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3248 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3249 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3250 @end itemize
3251
3252 There can also be other issues.
3253 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3254 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3255 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3256 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3257 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3258 Agreement (NDA).
3259
3260 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3261 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3262 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3263
3264 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3265 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3266
3267 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3268
3269 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3270 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3271 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3272 allowing it to be deasserted.
3273 @end deffn
3274
3275 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3276 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3277 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3278 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3279 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3280 @end deffn
3281
3282 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3283 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3284 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3285 allowing it to be deasserted.
3286 @end deffn
3287
3288 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3289 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3290 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3291 @end deffn
3292
3293 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3294 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3295 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3296 configuration scripts.
3297
3298 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3299 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3300 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3301 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3302 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3303 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3304 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3305 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3306
3307 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3308 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3309 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3310 -- may be specified at a time.
3311 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3312 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3313 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3314 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3315 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3316
3317 @itemize
3318 @item
3319 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3320 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3321 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3322 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3323 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3324
3325 @quotation Tip
3326 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3327 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3328 @end quotation
3329
3330 @item
3331 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3332 signal implementations.
3333 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3334 indicating everything behaves normally.
3335 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3336 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3337 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3338 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3339 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3340 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3341 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3342
3343 @item
3344 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3345 JTAG may be unvailable during reset.
3346 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3347 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3348 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3349 while SRST is asserted.
3350 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3351 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3352
3353 @item
3354 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3355 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3356 is required to use this option.
3357 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3358 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3359 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3360 be asserted before any target connection.
3361 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3362 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3363 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3364 @end itemize
3365
3366 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3367 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3368 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3369 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3370 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3371
3372 @itemize
3373 @item
3374 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3375 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3376 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3377 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3378
3379 @item
3380 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3381 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3382 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3383 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3384 powerup and pressing a reset button.
3385 @end itemize
3386 @end deffn
3387
3388 @section Custom Reset Handling
3389 @cindex events
3390
3391 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3392 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3393 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3394 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3395 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3396 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3397
3398 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3399 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3400 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3401 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3402 want to reset everything at once.
3403
3404 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3405 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3406 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3407 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3408 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3409 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3410 needs special attention.
3411
3412 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3413 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3414 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3415 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3416 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3417 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3418 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3419 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3420
3421 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3422 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3423 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3424 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3425 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3426
3427 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3428 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3429 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3430 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3431 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3432 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3433 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3434 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3435 or potentially some other value.
3436
3437 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3438 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3439 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3440 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3441 (or their associated targets)
3442 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3443
3444 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3445 they return.
3446 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3447 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3448 @end deffn
3449
3450 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3451 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3452 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3453 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3454 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3455 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3456 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3457 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3458 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3459 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3460 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3461 @end deffn
3462
3463 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3464 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3465 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3466 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3467 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3468 @end deffn
3469
3470
3471 @node TAP Declaration
3472 @chapter TAP Declaration
3473 @cindex TAP declaration
3474 @cindex TAP configuration
3475
3476 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3477 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3478
3479 @itemize @bullet
3480 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3481 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3482 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3483 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3484 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3485 start running that code.
3486 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3487 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3488 and missing connections.
3489 @end itemize
3490
3491 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3492 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3493 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3494 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3495 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3496
3497 @section Scan Chains
3498 @cindex scan chain
3499
3500 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3501 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3502 They also need to be added to
3503 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3504 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3505 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3506 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3507 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3508 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3509 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3510 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3511
3512 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3513 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3514 command, presented in the next chapter.
3515 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3516 debugging targets.)
3517 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3518
3519 @verbatim
3520 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3521 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3522 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3523 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3524 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3525 @end verbatim
3526
3527 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3528 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3529 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3530 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3531 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3532 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3533 until they are told to do so.
3534
3535 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3536 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3537 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3538 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3539
3540 @example
3541 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3542 @end example
3543
3544 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3545 by a given chip.
3546 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3547 and so forth.
3548 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3549 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3550 both inside a single chip and between them.
3551 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3552
3553 For example, the ST Microsystems STR912 chip has
3554 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3555 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3556 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3557 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3558 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3559 includes commands something like this:
3560
3561 @example
3562 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3563 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3564 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3565 @end example
3566
3567 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3568 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3569 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3570
3571 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3572 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3573 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3574 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3575 @example
3576 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3577 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3578 @}
3579 @end example
3580 @end deffn
3581
3582 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3583 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3584 and their status.
3585 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3586 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3587 but systems with a JTAG router can
3588 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3589 @end deffn
3590
3591 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3592 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3593
3594 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3595 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3596
3597 @section TAP Names
3598 @cindex dotted name
3599
3600 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3601 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3602 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3603 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3604 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3605 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3606 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3607 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3608
3609 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3610 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3611 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3612
3613 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3614
3615 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3616 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3617 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3618 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3619
3620 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3621 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3622 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3623 overridable.
3624
3625 @cindex TAP naming convention
3626 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3627 and should follow this convention:
3628
3629 @itemize @bullet
3630 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3631 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3632 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3633 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3634 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3635 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3636 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3637 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3638 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3639 with a single TAP;
3640 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3641 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3642 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3643 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3644 @end itemize
3645
3646 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3647
3648 @itemize @bullet
3649 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3650 @*The length in bits of the
3651 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3652 @end itemize
3653
3654 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3655
3656 @itemize @bullet
3657 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3658 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3659 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3660 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3661 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3662 (the TAP is linked in).
3663 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3664 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3665 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3666 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3667 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3668 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3669 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3670 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3671 values that were found but not included in the list.
3672
3673 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3674 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3675 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3676 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3677 hardware to find these values.
3678 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3679 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3680 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3681 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3682 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3683 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3684 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3685 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3686 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3687 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3688 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3689 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3690 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3691 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3692 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3693 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3694 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3695 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3696 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3697 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3698 @end itemize
3699 @end deffn
3700
3701 @section Other TAP commands
3702
3703 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3704 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3705 At this writing this TAP attribute
3706 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3707 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3708 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3709 See the next section for information about the available events.
3710
3711 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3712 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3713 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3714 @end deffn
3715
3716 @section TAP Events
3717 @cindex events
3718 @cindex TAP events
3719
3720 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3721 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3722 The other applies to debugger targets,
3723 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3724
3725 The TAP events currently defined are:
3726
3727 @itemize @bullet
3728 @item @b{post-reset}
3729 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3730 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3731 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3732 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3733 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3734
3735 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3736 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3737 of any particular target.
3738 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3739 @item @b{setup}
3740 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3741 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3742 @item @b{tap-disable}
3743 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3744 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3745 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3746 @item @b{tap-enable}
3747 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3748 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3749 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3750 @end itemize
3751
3752 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3753 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3754 contents to be accurate), you might:
3755
3756 @example
3757 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3758 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3759 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3760 @}
3761 @end example
3762
3763
3764 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3765 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3766 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3767 @cindex jrc
3768
3769 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3770 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3771 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3772 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3773 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3774
3775 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3776 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3777 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3778 be visible.
3779 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3780 ignores, such as:
3781
3782 @itemize
3783 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3784 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3785 TAPs receive new instructions.
3786 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3787 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3788 @end itemize
3789
3790 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3791 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3792 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3793 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3794
3795 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3796 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3797
3798 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3799 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3800 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3801 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3802 should define TAP event handlers using
3803 code that looks something like this:
3804
3805 @example
3806 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3807 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3808 @}
3809 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3810 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3811 @}
3812 @end example
3813
3814 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3815
3816 @example
3817 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3818 @end example
3819
3820 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
3821 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
3822 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
3823 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
3824
3825 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
3826 If necessary, disables the tap
3827 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
3828 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3829 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3830 and "0" if it is disabled.
3831 @end deffn
3832
3833 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
3834 If necessary, enables the tap
3835 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
3836 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3837 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3838 and "0" if it is disabled.
3839 @end deffn
3840
3841 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
3842 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3843 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3844 and "0" if it is disabled.
3845
3846 @quotation Note
3847 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
3848 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
3849 @end quotation
3850 @end deffn
3851
3852 @anchor{autoprobing}
3853 @section Autoprobing
3854 @cindex autoprobe
3855 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
3856
3857 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
3858 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
3859 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
3860 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
3861
3862 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
3863 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
3864 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
3865 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
3866 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
3867 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
3868 right when they come out of reset).
3869
3870 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
3871
3872 @example
3873 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
3874 reset_config trst_and_srst
3875 jtag_rclk 8
3876 @end example
3877
3878 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
3879 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
3880
3881 @enumerate
3882 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
3883 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
3884 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
3885 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
3886 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
3887 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
3888 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
3889 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
3890 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
3891 that is discovered.
3892 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
3893 register, it will report it.
3894 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
3895 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
3896 @end enumerate
3897
3898 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
3899 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
3900 that's a bit more complex:
3901
3902 @example
3903 clock speed 8 kHz
3904 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
3905 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
3906 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
3907 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
3908 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3909 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3910 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
3911 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
3912 @end example
3913
3914 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
3915 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
3916 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
3917 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
3918 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
3919 and so forth.
3920
3921 @node CPU Configuration
3922 @chapter CPU Configuration
3923 @cindex GDB target
3924
3925 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
3926 You can also access these targets without GDB
3927 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
3928 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
3929 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
3930 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
3931
3932 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
3933 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
3934
3935 @section Target List
3936 @cindex target, current
3937 @cindex target, list
3938
3939 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
3940 where each member has a name.
3941 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
3942 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
3943 (plural!) command.
3944 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
3945 look like with more than one:
3946 @verbatim
3947 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
3948 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
3949 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
3950 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
3951 @end verbatim
3952
3953 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
3954 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
3955 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
3956 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
3957 space seen by that current target.
3958 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
3959 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
3960 are examples; and there are many more.
3961
3962 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
3963
3964 @deffn Command {target current}
3965 Returns the name of the current target.
3966 @end deffn
3967
3968 @deffn Command {target names}
3969 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
3970 @example
3971 foreach t [target names] @{
3972 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
3973 @}
3974 @end example
3975 @end deffn
3976
3977 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
3978 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
3979
3980 @deffn Command targets [name]
3981 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
3982 command names are singular.}
3983
3984 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
3985 targets in a user friendly form.
3986
3987 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
3988 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
3989 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
3990 @end deffn
3991
3992 @section Target CPU Types
3993 @cindex target type
3994 @cindex CPU type
3995
3996 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
3997 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
3998 when calling @command{target create}.
3999 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4000 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4001 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4002 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4003 what core-specific commands may be available
4004 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4005 and more.
4006
4007 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4008 since there's a command to list them.
4009
4010 @anchor{targettypes}
4011 @deffn Command {target types}
4012 Lists all supported target types.
4013 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4014
4015 @itemize @bullet
4016 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4017 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4018 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4019 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4020 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4021 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4022 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4023 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4024 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4025 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4026 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4027 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4028 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4029 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4030 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4031 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4032 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4033 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4034 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4035 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4036 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4037 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4038 @itemize @minus
4039 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4040 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4041 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4042 @end itemize
4043 And two debug interfaces cores:
4044 @itemize @minus
4045 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4046 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4047 @end itemize
4048 @end itemize
4049 @end deffn
4050
4051 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4052 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4053 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4054 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4055 licenced, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4056 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4057 reflect design generations;
4058 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, and ARMv7
4059 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4060
4061 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4062 @section Target Configuration
4063
4064 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4065 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4066 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4067 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4068 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4069
4070 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4071 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4072 optional parts.
4073 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4074 command, created as part of target creation.
4075
4076 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4077 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4078 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4079 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4080 to be much more board-specific.
4081 The key steps you use might look something like this
4082
4083 @example
4084 target create MyTarget cortex_m -chain-position mychip.cpu
4085 $MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4086 $MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4087 $MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4088 @end example
4089
4090 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4091 on-chip SRAM.
4092 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4093 writes to target memory;
4094 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4095 GDB memory checksumming;
4096 and more.
4097
4098 @quotation Warning
4099 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4100 inaccessible when application code
4101 (such as an operating system)
4102 enables or disables the MMU.
4103 For example, the particular MMU context used to acess the virtual
4104 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4105 easy access to other addresses needed.
4106 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4107 @end quotation
4108
4109 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4110 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4111 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4112 controllers.
4113 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4114 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4115 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4116
4117 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4118 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4119 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4120 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4121 purposes including additional configuration.
4122
4123 @itemize @bullet
4124 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4125 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4126 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4127 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4128
4129 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4130 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4131 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4132 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4133 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4134 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4135 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4136
4137 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} here.
4138 @end itemize
4139 @end deffn
4140
4141 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4142 The options accepted by this command may also be
4143 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4144 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4145 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4146
4147 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4148 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4149 and changing its endianness.
4150
4151 @itemize @bullet
4152
4153 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4154 used to access this target.
4155
4156 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4157 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4158
4159 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4160 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4161 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4162 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4163 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4164 same event name assigns only one handler.
4165
4166 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4167 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4168 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4169 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4170 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4171 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4172 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4173
4174 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4175 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4176 or virtual address is being used.
4177
4178 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4179 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4180
4181 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4182 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4183 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4184 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4185 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4186
4187 @anchor{rtostype}
4188 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4189 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}|@option{eCos}|@option{ThreadX}|
4190 @option{FreeRTOS}|@option{linux}|@option{ChibiOS}|@option{embKernel}|@option{mqx}
4191 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4192
4193 @end itemize
4194 @end deffn
4195
4196 @section Other $target_name Commands
4197 @cindex object command
4198
4199 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4200 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4201
4202 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4203 Once a button is created a button
4204 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4205 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4206 configure it like this:
4207
4208 @example
4209 # Create
4210 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4211 # Modify
4212 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4213 # Query
4214 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4215 # Report
4216 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4217 @end example
4218
4219 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4220 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4221
4222 @example
4223 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4224 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4225 @end example
4226
4227 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4228
4229 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine}
4230 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4231 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4232 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4233 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4234 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4235 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4236 They are not otherwise documented here.
4237 @end deffn
4238
4239 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4240 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4241 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4242 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4243 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4244 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4245 the target side uses raw memory.
4246
4247 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4248 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4249 The script orientation comes from working with data
4250 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4251 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4252 and neither store nor return those values.
4253
4254 @itemize
4255 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4256 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4257 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4258 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4259 @end itemize
4260 @end deffn
4261
4262 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4263 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4264 @command{$target_name configure}
4265 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4266 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4267 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4268 There are a few special cases:
4269
4270 @itemize @bullet
4271 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4272 event named @var{event_name}.
4273 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4274 two parameters.
4275 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4276 This is a special case because this is set using
4277 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4278 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4279 @end itemize
4280
4281 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4282 all the targets you might use something like this:
4283
4284 @example
4285 foreach name [target names] @{
4286 set y [$name cget -endian]
4287 set z [$name cget -type]
4288 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4289 $x $name $y $z]
4290 @}
4291 @end example
4292 @end deffn
4293
4294 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4295 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4296 Displays the current target state:
4297 @code{debug-running},
4298 @code{halted},
4299 @code{reset},
4300 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4301 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4302 @end deffn
4303
4304 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4305 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4306 currently associated with this target.
4307 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4308 @end deffn
4309
4310 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4311 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4312 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4313 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4314 @end deffn
4315
4316 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4317 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4318 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4319 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4320 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4321 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4322 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4323 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4324 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4325 @end deffn
4326
4327 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4328 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4329 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4330 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4331 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4332 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4333 @end deffn
4334
4335 @anchor{targetevents}
4336 @section Target Events
4337 @cindex target events
4338 @cindex events
4339 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4340 For example:
4341 @itemize @bullet
4342 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4343 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4344 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4345 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4346 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4347 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4348 to set up system clocks or
4349 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4350 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4351 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4352 @end itemize
4353
4354 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4355 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4356 @command{target create ... -event}.
4357
4358 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4359 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4360 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4361
4362 @example
4363 proc my_attach_proc @{ @} @{
4364 echo "Reset..."
4365 reset halt
4366 @}
4367 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach my_attach_proc
4368 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach @{
4369 echo "Reset..."
4370 # To make flash probe and gdb load to flash work
4371 # we need a reset init.
4372 reset init
4373 @}
4374 @end example
4375
4376 The following target events are defined:
4377
4378 @itemize @bullet
4379 @item @b{debug-halted}
4380 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4381 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4382 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: gdb said run)
4383 @item @b{early-halted}
4384 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4385 @item @b{examine-start}
4386 @* Before target examine is called.
4387 @item @b{examine-end}
4388 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4389 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4390 @* When GDB connects. This is before any communication with the target, so this
4391 can be used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash. Probing flash
4392 is necessary during gdb connect if gdb load is to write the image to flash. Another
4393 use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically hardware/software breakpoints
4394 depending on whether the breakpoint is in RAM or read only memory.
4395 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4396 @* When GDB disconnects
4397 @item @b{gdb-end}
4398 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4399 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4400 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4401 @code{reset init})
4402 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4403 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4404 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4405 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4406 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4407 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4408 @item @b{gdb-start}
4409 @* Before the target steps, gdb is trying to start/resume the target
4410 @item @b{halted}
4411 @* The target has halted
4412 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4413 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4414 after @command{reset_init} was triggered
4415 but before either SRST alone is re-asserted on the scan chain,
4416 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4417 @item @b{reset-assert}
4418 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4419 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4420 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4421 it instead of asserting SRST.
4422 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4423 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4424 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4425 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4426 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4427 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4428 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4429 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4430 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4431 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4432 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4433 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4434 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4435 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4436 released on the scan chain.
4437 @item @b{reset-end}
4438 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4439 @ignore
4440 @item @b{reset-halt-post}
4441 @* Currently not used
4442 @item @b{reset-halt-pre}
4443 @* Currently not used
4444 @end ignore
4445 @item @b{reset-init}
4446 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4447 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4448
4449 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4450 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4451 multiplexing, and so on.
4452 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4453 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4454 @item @b{reset-start}
4455 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4456 before @command{reset_init} is called.
4457
4458 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4459 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4460 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4461 @ignore
4462 @item @b{reset-wait-pos}
4463 @* Currently not used
4464 @item @b{reset-wait-pre}
4465 @* Currently not used
4466 @end ignore
4467 @item @b{resume-start}
4468 @* Before any target is resumed
4469 @item @b{resume-end}
4470 @* After all targets have resumed
4471 @item @b{resumed}
4472 @* Target has resumed
4473 @item @b{trace-config}
4474 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4475 @end itemize
4476
4477 @node Flash Commands
4478 @chapter Flash Commands
4479
4480 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4481 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4482 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4483 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4484 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4485 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4486 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4487 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4488 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4489
4490 Flash Steps:
4491 @enumerate
4492 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4493 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4494 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4495 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4496 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4497 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4498 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4499 @item GDB Flashing
4500 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4501 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4502 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4503 @end enumerate
4504
4505 Many CPUs have the ablity to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4506 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4507 so that it can't boot.
4508 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4509 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4510
4511 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4512 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4513 @cindex flash configuration
4514
4515 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4516 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4517 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4518 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4519 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4520 see the driver-specific documentation.
4521
4522 @itemize @bullet
4523 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4524 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4525 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4526 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4527 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4528 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4529 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4530 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4531 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4532 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4533 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4534 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4535 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4536 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4537 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4538 commands to the flash controller.
4539 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4540 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4541 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4542 for more information.
4543 @end itemize
4544 @quotation Note
4545 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4546 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4547 @end quotation
4548 @end deffn
4549
4550 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4551 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4552 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4553 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4554 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4555 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4556 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4557 @end deffn
4558
4559 @deffn Command {flash list}
4560 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4561 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4562 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4563 @end deffn
4564
4565 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4566 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4567 depends on the flash type.
4568 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4569 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4570 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4571 but most don't bother.
4572 @end deffn
4573
4574 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4575 @cindex flash erasing
4576 @cindex flash reading
4577 @cindex flash writing
4578 @cindex flash programming
4579 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4580
4581 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4582 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressible memory.
4583 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4584 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4585 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4586
4587 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4588 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4589 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4590 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4591 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4592
4593 @quotation Note
4594 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4595 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4596 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4597 back to a flash bank.
4598 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4599 @comment with that target doesn't succesfuly autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4600 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4601 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4602 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4603 @end quotation
4604
4605 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4606 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4607 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4608 disabled first.
4609 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4610 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4611 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4612
4613 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4614 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4615 up to and including @var{last}.
4616 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4617 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4618 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4619 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4620 @end deffn
4621
4622 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4623 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4624 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4625 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4626 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4627 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4628 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4629 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4630 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4631 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4632 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4633 before erase starts.
4634 @end deffn
4635
4636 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4637 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4638 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4639 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4640 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4641 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4642 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4643 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4644 before issuing this command.
4645 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4646 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4647 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4648 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4649 @end deffn
4650 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4651
4652 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename offset
4653 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
4654 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
4655 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4656 @end deffn
4657
4658 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename offset length
4659 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
4660 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}.
4661 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4662 @end deffn
4663
4664 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename offset
4665 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
4666 flash @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. Fails if the contents do not match.
4667 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4668 @end deffn
4669
4670 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
4671 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
4672 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
4673 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
4674 to the base address for each section in the image.
4675 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
4676 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
4677 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
4678 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
4679 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
4680 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
4681 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
4682 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
4683 each image section.
4684
4685 @quotation Warning
4686 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
4687 data you want to preserve.
4688 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
4689 sections might be erased with no notice.
4690 @itemize
4691 @item
4692 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
4693 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
4694 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
4695 @item
4696 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
4697 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
4698 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
4699 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
4700 @end itemize
4701 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
4702 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
4703 @end quotation
4704
4705 @end deffn
4706
4707 @section Other Flash commands
4708 @cindex flash protection
4709
4710 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
4711 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
4712 and display that status.
4713 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4714 @end deffn
4715
4716 @deffn Command {flash info} num
4717 Print info about flash bank @var{num}
4718 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4719 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
4720 and possibly stale information.
4721 @end deffn
4722
4723 @anchor{flashprotect}
4724 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
4725 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash sectors
4726 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4727 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
4728 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4729 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4730 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4731 @end deffn
4732
4733 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
4734 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
4735 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
4736 comamnd or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
4737 @end deffn
4738
4739 @anchor{program}
4740 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
4741 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
4742 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
4743 @xref{Flash Programming}.
4744 @end deffn
4745
4746 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
4747 @section Flash Driver List
4748 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
4749 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
4750 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
4751
4752 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
4753 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
4754 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
4755
4756 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
4757
4758 @itemize
4759 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
4760 @end itemize
4761
4762 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
4763 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any cmds executed on
4764 the virtual banks are actually performed on the physical banks.
4765 @example
4766 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4767 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4768 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4769 @end example
4770 @end deffn
4771
4772 @subsection External Flash
4773
4774 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
4775 @cindex Common Flash Interface
4776 @cindex CFI
4777 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
4778 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
4779 specific external chip select on the CPU.
4780 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
4781 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
4782 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
4783 configure a bus and its timings), or
4784 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
4785 on the flash chip.
4786 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
4787 speed up operation.
4788
4789 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
4790
4791 @itemize
4792 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
4793 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
4794 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
4795 @end itemize
4796
4797 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
4798 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
4799
4800 @example
4801 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4802 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4803 @end example
4804
4805 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
4806 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
4807 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
4808
4809 @example
4810 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
4811 @end example
4812
4813 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
4814 @end deffn
4815
4816 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
4817 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
4818 @cindex SPI
4819 @cindex jtagspi
4820 @cindex bscan_spi
4821 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
4822 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
4823 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
4824 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
4825 accessed through JTAG.
4826
4827 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
4828 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
4829 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
4830 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
4831 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires migen
4832 (@url{http://github.com/m-labs/migen}) and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
4833
4834 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
4835 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
4836 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
4837 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
4838 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
4839 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
4840 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
4841 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
4842
4843 @itemize
4844 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
4845 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
4846 @var{USER1} instruction.
4847 @item @var{dr_length} ... is the length of the DR register. This will be 1 for
4848 @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} bitstreams and most other cases.
4849 @end itemize
4850
4851 @example
4852 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
4853 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
4854 set _DR_LENGTH 1
4855 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1 $_DR_LENGTH
4856 @end example
4857 @end deffn
4858
4859 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
4860 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
4861 @cindex SPIFI
4862 @cindex lpcspifi
4863 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
4864 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
4865 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
4866
4867 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
4868 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
4869 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
4870 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
4871 significantly reduce flash programming times.
4872
4873 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
4874 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
4875 are configured by the driver.
4876
4877 @example
4878 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4879 @end example
4880
4881 @end deffn
4882
4883 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
4884 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
4885 @cindex SMI
4886 @cindex stmsmi
4887 Some devices form STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
4888 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
4889 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
4890 SPI flash devices.
4891 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
4892 flash devices can be connected.
4893
4894 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
4895 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
4896 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
4897 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
4898 the flash content.
4899
4900 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
4901 to identify the memory bank.
4902 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
4903 flash size, are detected automatically.
4904
4905 @example
4906 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4907 @end example
4908
4909 @end deffn
4910
4911 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
4912 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
4913 Microcontroller platform.
4914
4915 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
4916 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
4917
4918 @example
4919 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
4920 @end example
4921
4922 @end deffn
4923
4924 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
4925
4926 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
4927 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
4928 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
4929 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
4930 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
4931 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
4932
4933 @example
4934 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4935 @end example
4936 @end deffn
4937
4938 @anchor{at91samd}
4939 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
4940 @cindex at91samd
4941 All members of the ATSAMD, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
4942 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
4943 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
4944
4945 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
4946 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
4947 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
4948 processor to be halted.
4949 @end deffn
4950
4951 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
4952 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
4953 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
4954 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
4955 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
4956 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
4957
4958 @example
4959 at91samd set-security enable
4960 @end example
4961 @end deffn
4962
4963 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
4964 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
4965 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
4966 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
4967 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
4968 requires additional firmware support and the minumum EEPROM size may not be
4969 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
4970 in order to disable this feature.
4971
4972 @example
4973 at91samd eeprom
4974 at91samd eeprom 1024
4975 @end example
4976 @end deffn
4977
4978 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
4979 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
4980 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
4981 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
4982 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
4983 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
4984
4985 @example
4986 at91samd bootloader
4987 at91samd bootloader 16384
4988 @end example
4989 @end deffn
4990
4991 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
4992 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
4993 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
4994 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
4995 @end deffn
4996
4997 @end deffn
4998
4999 @anchor{at91sam3}
5000 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5001 @cindex at91sam3
5002 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5003 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5004 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5005 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5006 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5007 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5008 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrysome comment after other
5009 chips are confirmed.}
5010
5011 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5012 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5013 the following fixed locations:
5014
5015 @example
5016 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5017 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5018 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5019 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5020 @end example
5021
5022 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5023 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5024 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5025
5026 @itemize
5027 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5028 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5029 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5030 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5031 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5032 @end itemize
5033
5034 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5035
5036 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5037 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5038 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5039 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5040 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5041 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5042 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5043
5044 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5045 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5046 @end deffn
5047
5048 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5049 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5050 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5051 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5052 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5053 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5054 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5055 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5056 @end deffn
5057
5058 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5059 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5060 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5061 @end deffn
5062 @end deffn
5063
5064 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5065 @cindex at91sam4
5066 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5067 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5068 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5069 @end deffn
5070
5071 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5072 @cindex at91sam4l
5073 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5074 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5075 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5076
5077 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5078 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5079 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5080 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5081 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5082 @end deffn
5083 @end deffn
5084
5085 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5086 @cindex atsamv
5087 All members of the ATSAMV, ATSAMS, and ATSAME families from
5088 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5089 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5090 @end deffn
5091
5092 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5093 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5094 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5095 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5096 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5097
5098 @example
5099 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5100 @end example
5101
5102 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5103 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5104
5105 @itemize
5106 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5107 @item @var{banks}
5108 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5109 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5110 @item @var{pages_size}
5111 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5112 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5113 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5114 @end itemize
5115
5116 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5117 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5118 will be autoconfigured.
5119 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5120
5121 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5122 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5123 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5124 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5125 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5126
5127 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5128 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5129 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5130 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5131 are not truly general purpose).
5132 @quotation Note
5133 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5134 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5135 @end quotation
5136 @end deffn
5137 @end deffn
5138
5139 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5140 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5141 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5142 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5143 @end deffn
5144
5145 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5146 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5147 internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5148 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5149 autoconfigures itself.
5150 @example
5151 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5152 @end example
5153 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5154 supported.}
5155 @end deffn
5156
5157 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5158 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5159 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores.
5160 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5161 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5162 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5163 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5164
5165 @example
5166 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5167 @end example
5168 @end deffn
5169
5170 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5171 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5172 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
5173 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000 and LPC54100
5174 microcontroller families from NXP.
5175
5176 @quotation Note
5177 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5178 driver:
5179 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5180 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5181 @end quotation
5182
5183 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and one optional parameters,
5184 which must appear in the following order:
5185
5186 @itemize
5187 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5188 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5189 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5190 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
5191 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5192 LPC43x[2357])
5193 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
5194 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5195 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
5196 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
5197 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
5198 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5199 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx and LPC40xx
5200 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5201 at which the core is running
5202 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5203 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5204 @quotation Note
5205 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5206 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5207 However, if you do provide it,
5208 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5209 @end quotation
5210 @end itemize
5211
5212 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5213
5214 @example
5215 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5216 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5217 @end example
5218
5219 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5220 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5221 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5222 @end deffn
5223 @end deffn
5224
5225 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5226 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5227 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5228 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5229 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5230 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5231
5232 @example
5233 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5234 @end example
5235 @end deffn
5236
5237 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5238 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5239 from NXP.
5240
5241 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5242 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5243 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5244 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5245 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5246 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5247 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5248 you start the PLL.
5249
5250 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5251
5252 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5253 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5254 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5255
5256 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5257 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5258 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5259 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5260 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5261 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
5262 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
5263
5264 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
5265 @example
5266 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
5267 @end example
5268
5269 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
5270 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
5271 @code{flash banks} command.
5272
5273 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
5274 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
5275 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
5276 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
5277 a known signature.
5278 Example:
5279 @example
5280 lpc2900 signature 0
5281 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
5282 @end example
5283 @end deffn
5284
5285 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
5286 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
5287 saves it to a file in binary format.
5288 Example:
5289 @example
5290 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
5291 @end example
5292 @end deffn
5293
5294 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
5295 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
5296 commands need to be preceeded by a successful call to the @code{password}
5297 command:
5298
5299 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
5300 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
5301 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
5302 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
5303
5304 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
5305 Example:
5306 @example
5307 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
5308 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
5309 @end example
5310 @end deffn
5311
5312 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
5313 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
5314 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
5315 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
5316 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
5317 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
5318 912 bytes.
5319 @quotation Attention
5320 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5321 @end quotation
5322 Example:
5323 @example
5324 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
5325 @end example
5326 @end deffn
5327
5328 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
5329 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
5330 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
5331 after the next power cycle.
5332 @quotation Attention
5333 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5334 @end quotation
5335 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
5336 Example:
5337 @example
5338 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
5339 flash info 0
5340 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
5341 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5342 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
5343 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5344 @end example
5345 @end deffn
5346
5347 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
5348 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
5349 effective after the next power cycle.
5350 @quotation Attention
5351 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5352 @end quotation
5353 Examples:
5354 @example
5355 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
5356 @end example
5357 @end deffn
5358 @end deffn
5359
5360 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
5361 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
5362 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
5363 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
5364
5365 @example
5366 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
5367 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
5368 @end example
5369
5370 @itemize @bullet
5371 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
5372 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
5373 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
5374 @end itemize
5375
5376 Example usage:
5377 @example
5378 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
5379 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
5380 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
5381 @} else @{
5382 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
5383 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
5384 @}
5385 @end example
5386 @end deffn
5387
5388 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
5389 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
5390 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5391 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
5392 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
5393 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
5394 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
5395 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
5396 also have division into regions: main and info.
5397 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
5398 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memmory.
5399
5400 @example
5401 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5402 @end example
5403
5404 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
5405
5406 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
5407 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
5408 @end deffn
5409
5410 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
5411 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
5412 @end deffn
5413
5414 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
5415 Erase all userflash including info region.
5416 @end deffn
5417
5418 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
5419 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
5420 @end deffn
5421
5422 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
5423 Check sectors protect.
5424 @end deffn
5425
5426 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
5427 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
5428 @end deffn
5429
5430 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
5431 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
5432 @end deffn
5433
5434 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
5435 Configure external memory interface for boot.
5436 @end deffn
5437
5438 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
5439 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
5440 @end deffn
5441
5442 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
5443 Show information about flash driver.
5444 @end deffn
5445
5446 @end deffn
5447
5448 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf51
5449 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
5450 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
5451
5452 @example
5453 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf51 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5454 @end example
5455
5456 Some nrf51-specific commands are defined:
5457
5458 @deffn Command {nrf51 mass_erase}
5459 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
5460 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
5461 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
5462 code.
5463 @end deffn
5464
5465 @end deffn
5466
5467 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
5468 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
5469 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
5470
5471 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
5472 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
5473 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
5474 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
5475
5476 @example
5477 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5478 @end example
5479 @end deffn
5480
5481 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
5482 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
5483 and integrate flash memory.
5484
5485 @example
5486 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5487 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5488 @end example
5489
5490 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
5491 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5492 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
5493 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
5494 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
5495 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
5496 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
5497 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
5498 @end deffn
5499 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
5500 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
5501 This will remove any Code Protection.
5502 @end deffn
5503 @end deffn
5504
5505 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
5506 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
5507 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M0 cores.
5508 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5509 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5510
5511 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
5512 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
5513
5514 @example
5515 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5516 @end example
5517
5518 psoc4-specific commands
5519 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
5520 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
5521
5522 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
5523 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
5524
5525 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
5526 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
5527 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
5528
5529 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5530 @end deffn
5531
5532 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
5533 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
5534
5535 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5536 @end deffn
5537 @end deffn
5538
5539 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
5540 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
5541 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
5542 and SWD interface.
5543 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
5544 If this failes, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
5545
5546 @example
5547 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5548 @end example
5549
5550 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
5551
5552 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
5553 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
5554 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
5555 @end deffn
5556
5557 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
5558 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
5559 @end deffn
5560 @end deffn
5561
5562 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
5563 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
5564 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
5565 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
5566 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5567 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stellaris mass_erase} command.
5568 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5569 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5570
5571 @example
5572 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5573 @end example
5574
5575 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
5576 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
5577 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
5578 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
5579 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
5580 disabled.
5581
5582 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
5583 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
5584 @quotation Warning
5585 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
5586 applied to all of them.
5587 @end quotation
5588 @end deffn
5589 @end deffn
5590
5591 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
5592 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
5593 from ST Microelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
5594 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5595 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5596
5597 @example
5598 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5599 @end example
5600
5601 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5602 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5603 the flash driver.
5604
5605 @example
5606 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5607 @end example
5608
5609 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
5610 as per the following example.
5611 @example
5612 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5613 @end example
5614
5615 Some stm32f1x-specific commands
5616 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stm32f1x mass_erase} command.
5617 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5618 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5619 are defined:
5620
5621 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
5622 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5623 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5624 @end deffn
5625
5626 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
5627 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5628 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5629 @end deffn
5630
5631 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
5632 Read and display the stm32 option bytes written by
5633 the @command{stm32f1x options_write} command.
5634 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5635 @end deffn
5636
5637 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
5638 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
5639 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5640 @end deffn
5641 @end deffn
5642
5643 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
5644 All members of the STM32F2 and STM32F4 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5645 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4 cores.
5646 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5647 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5648
5649 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5650 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5651 the flash driver.
5652
5653 @example
5654 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5655 @end example
5656
5657 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
5658
5659 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
5660 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5661 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5662 @end deffn
5663
5664 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
5665 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5666 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5667 @end deffn
5668 @end deffn
5669
5670 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
5671 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5672 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
5673 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5674 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5675
5676 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5677 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5678 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
5679 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
5680 second bank.
5681
5682 @example
5683 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5684 @end example
5685
5686 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
5687
5688 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
5689 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
5690 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
5691 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
5692 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5693 @end deffn
5694 @end deffn
5695
5696 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
5697 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5698 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5699 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
5700 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
5701
5702 @example
5703 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
5704 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
5705 @end example
5706
5707 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
5708 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
5709 for the specified flash bank.
5710 @end deffn
5711 @end deffn
5712
5713 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
5714 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5715 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
5716 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
5717 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
5718
5719 @example
5720 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5721 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
5722 @end example
5723
5724 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
5725 Configures the str9 flash controller.
5726 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5727
5728 @itemize @bullet
5729 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
5730 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
5731 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5732 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5733 @end itemize
5734 @end deffn
5735
5736 @end deffn
5737
5738 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
5739 @cindex str9xpec
5740
5741 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
5742 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
5743 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
5744 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
5745
5746 Here is some background info to help
5747 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
5748 the str9:
5749 @enumerate
5750 @item
5751 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
5752 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
5753 @item
5754 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
5755 ISC compilant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
5756 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
5757 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
5758 @end enumerate
5759
5760 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
5761 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
5762 configured for flash bank 0.
5763 @example
5764 # assert srst, we do not want core running
5765 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
5766 jtag_reset 0 1
5767 # turn off target polling
5768 poll off
5769 # disable str9 core
5770 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
5771 # read option bytes
5772 str9xpec options_read 0
5773 # re-enable str9 core
5774 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
5775 poll on
5776 reset halt
5777 @end example
5778 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
5779 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
5780 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
5781 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
5782
5783 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
5784
5785 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
5786 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
5787 @end deffn
5788
5789 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
5790 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
5791 directly to the embedded flash controller.
5792 @end deffn
5793
5794 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
5795 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
5796 erase the device.
5797 @end deffn
5798
5799 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
5800 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
5801 @end deffn
5802
5803 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
5804 Configure str9 boot bank.
5805 @end deffn
5806
5807 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5808 Configure str9 lvd source.
5809 @end deffn
5810
5811 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
5812 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
5813 @end deffn
5814
5815 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5816 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
5817 @end deffn
5818
5819 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
5820 Read str9 option bytes.
5821 @end deffn
5822
5823 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
5824 Write str9 option bytes.
5825 @end deffn
5826
5827 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
5828 unlock str9 device.
5829 @end deffn
5830
5831 @end deffn
5832
5833 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
5834 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
5835 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5836 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5837
5838 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
5839
5840 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
5841 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
5842 @end deffn
5843
5844 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
5845 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
5846 @end deffn
5847
5848 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
5849 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
5850 the flash clock.
5851 @end deffn
5852 @end deffn
5853
5854 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
5855 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
5856 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5857
5858 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
5859
5860 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
5861 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
5862 @end deffn
5863
5864 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
5865 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
5866 @end deffn
5867
5868 @end deffn
5869
5870 @section NAND Flash Commands
5871 @cindex NAND
5872
5873 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
5874 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
5875 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
5876
5877 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
5878 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
5879 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
5880 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
5881 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
5882 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
5883
5884 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
5885 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
5886 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
5887 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
5888 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
5889 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
5890 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
5891 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
5892 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
5893 with techniques such as wear leveling.
5894
5895 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
5896 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
5897 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
5898 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
5899 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
5900 every 512 bytes of data.
5901
5902 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
5903 OpenOCD includes the apppropriate kind of ECC. For example,
5904 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
5905 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
5906 ECC mode is used.
5907
5908 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
5909 @enumerate
5910 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
5911 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5912 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
5913 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
5914 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
5915 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
5916 to access that device.
5917 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
5918 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5919 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
5920 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
5921 de-brick a board.
5922 @end enumerate
5923
5924 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
5925 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
5926 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
5927 are only 32 bits wide.
5928 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
5929 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
5930 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
5931 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
5932
5933 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
5934 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
5935 @cindex NAND configuration
5936
5937 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
5938 plus some additional configuration that's done after
5939 OpenOCD has initialized.
5940
5941 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
5942 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
5943 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
5944 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
5945 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
5946 they were a single (larger) device.
5947 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
5948 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
5949
5950 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
5951 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
5952 configuration files, not interactively.
5953
5954 @itemize @bullet
5955 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
5956 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
5957 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
5958 associated with the NAND device being declared.
5959 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
5960 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
5961 commands to the NAND controller.
5962 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5963 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
5964 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
5965 for more information.
5966 @end itemize
5967 @end deffn
5968
5969 @deffn Command {nand list}
5970 Prints a summary of each device declared
5971 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
5972 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
5973 @example
5974 > nand list
5975 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
5976 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
5977 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
5978 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
5979 >
5980 @end example
5981 @end deffn
5982
5983 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
5984 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
5985 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
5986 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5987 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
5988 it with most other NAND commands.
5989 @end deffn
5990
5991 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
5992
5993 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
5994 @cindex NAND reading
5995 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
5996 starting at the specified offset.
5997 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5998
5999 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6000 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6001
6002 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
6003 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
6004 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
6005
6006 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
6007 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
6008 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
6009 method which handled that error correction.
6010
6011 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
6012 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
6013 @itemize @bullet
6014 @item no oob_* parameter
6015 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
6016 @item @code{oob_raw}
6017 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
6018 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
6019 spare areas associated with each data page.
6020 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
6021 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
6022 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
6023 @item @code{oob_only}
6024 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
6025 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
6026 spare areas associated with each data page.
6027 @end itemize
6028 @end deffn
6029
6030 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
6031 @cindex NAND erasing
6032 @cindex NAND programming
6033 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
6034 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
6035 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6036 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6037 If those parameters are not specified,
6038 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
6039 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6040
6041 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
6042 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
6043 block marker.
6044 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
6045 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
6046 @end deffn
6047
6048 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
6049 @cindex NAND writing
6050 @cindex NAND programming
6051 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
6052 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
6053 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
6054 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6055
6056 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6057 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6058
6059 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6060 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
6061 past the end of the device.
6062 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
6063 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
6064 if that's being written.)
6065
6066 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
6067 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
6068 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
6069
6070 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
6071 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
6072 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
6073 @itemize @bullet
6074 @item no oob_* parameter
6075 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6076 If raw acccess is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
6077 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6078 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
6079 with hardware-computed ECC data.
6080 @item @code{oob_only}
6081 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
6082 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
6083 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
6084 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
6085 @item @code{oob_raw}
6086 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
6087 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
6088 un-altered OOB.
6089 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6090 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
6091 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
6092 @item @code{oob_softecc}
6093 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6094 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
6095 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
6096 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6097 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6098 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
6099 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6100 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
6101 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
6102 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6103 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6104 @end itemize
6105 @end deffn
6106
6107 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
6108 @cindex NAND verification
6109 @cindex NAND programming
6110 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
6111 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
6112 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6113
6114 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6115 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6116
6117 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6118 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
6119 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
6120 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
6121 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
6122
6123 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
6124 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
6125 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
6126
6127 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
6128 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
6129 hardward-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
6130 be removed in a future release.
6131 @end deffn
6132
6133 @subsection Other NAND commands
6134 @cindex NAND other commands
6135
6136 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
6137 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
6138 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
6139 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
6140 continues for @var{length} bytes.
6141 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6142 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6143 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6144
6145 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
6146 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
6147 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
6148 @end deffn
6149
6150 @deffn Command {nand info} num
6151 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6152 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
6153 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
6154 status for each block.
6155 @end deffn
6156
6157 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6158 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
6159 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6160
6161 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
6162 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
6163 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
6164 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
6165 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
6166
6167 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
6168 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
6169 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
6170 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
6171 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
6172 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
6173 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
6174 @end deffn
6175
6176 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
6177 @subsection NAND Driver List
6178 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
6179 driver-specific options and behaviors.
6180 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
6181
6182 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
6183 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
6184 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
6185 address of the ECC controller.
6186 @example
6187 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
6188 @end example
6189 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
6190 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
6191 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
6192 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
6193 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
6194 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
6195 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
6196 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6197 @end deffn
6198 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
6199 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
6200 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6201 @end deffn
6202
6203 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
6204 properly configured for input or output.
6205 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
6206 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
6207 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6208 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6209 @end deffn
6210 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
6211 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
6212 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6213 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6214 @end deffn
6215 @end deffn
6216
6217 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
6218 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
6219 chips from Texas Instruments.
6220 It takes three extra parameters:
6221 address of the NAND chip;
6222 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
6223 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
6224 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
6225 @example
6226 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
6227 @end example
6228 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
6229 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
6230 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
6231 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
6232 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
6233 @end deffn
6234
6235 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
6236 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6237 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
6238 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
6239 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
6240 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
6241 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6242 @end deffn
6243
6244 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
6245 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
6246 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
6247 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
6248 @end deffn
6249 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
6250
6251 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
6252 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
6253 should work for this chip aswell.
6254 @end deffn
6255
6256 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
6257 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
6258 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
6259 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
6260 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
6261 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
6262 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
6263 @example
6264 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
6265 @end example
6266 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
6267 Turns on/off bad block information swaping from main area,
6268 without parameter query status.
6269 @end deffn
6270 @end deffn
6271
6272 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
6273 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6274 parameter: the address of the controller.
6275 @example
6276 nand device orion 0xd8000000
6277 @end example
6278 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
6279 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6280 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6281 change any behavior.
6282 @end deffn
6283
6284 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
6285 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
6286 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
6287 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
6288 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
6289 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
6290 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
6291 specialized commands.
6292 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6293 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6294 change any behavior.
6295 @end deffn
6296
6297 @section mFlash
6298
6299 @subsection mFlash Configuration
6300 @cindex mFlash Configuration
6301
6302 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
6303 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
6304 address @var{base}.
6305 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
6306 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
6307
6308 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
6309
6310 @example
6311 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
6312 @end example
6313
6314 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
6315
6316 @example
6317 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
6318 @end example
6319 @end deffn
6320
6321 @subsection mFlash commands
6322 @cindex mFlash commands
6323
6324 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
6325 Configure mflash PLL.
6326 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
6327 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
6328 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
6329 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
6330 @end deffn
6331
6332 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
6333 Configure bootable option.
6334 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
6335 (4kB) for boot.
6336 @end deffn
6337
6338 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
6339 Configure storage information.
6340 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
6341 written.
6342 @end deffn
6343
6344 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
6345 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
6346 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
6347 @end deffn
6348
6349 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
6350 Probe mflash.
6351 @end deffn
6352
6353 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
6354 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
6355 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
6356 @end deffn
6357
6358 @node Flash Programming
6359 @chapter Flash Programming
6360
6361 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
6362 Programming can be acheived by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
6363 or using the cmds given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
6364
6365 @*To simplify using the flash cmds directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
6366 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
6367
6368 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be peformed.
6369 @enumerate
6370 @item 'init' is executed.
6371 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
6372 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
6373 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
6374 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
6375 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
6376 @end enumerate
6377
6378 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
6379
6380 @example
6381 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
6382 # are optional parameters
6383 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6384 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
6385
6386 # binary files need the flash address passing
6387 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6388 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
6389 @end example
6390
6391 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
6392 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
6393 @cindex PLD
6394 @cindex FPGA
6395
6396 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
6397 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
6398 OpenOCD can support programming them.
6399 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
6400 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
6401 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
6402 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
6403
6404 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
6405
6406 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
6407 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
6408 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
6409
6410 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
6411 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
6412
6413 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
6414 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
6415 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
6416 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
6417 behavior.
6418 @end deffn
6419
6420 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
6421 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
6422 @end deffn
6423
6424 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
6425 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
6426 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
6427 @end deffn
6428
6429 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
6430
6431 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
6432 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
6433 that particular type of PLD.
6434
6435 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
6436 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
6437 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
6438
6439 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
6440 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
6441 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
6442
6443 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
6444 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
6445 for FPGA @var{num}.
6446 @end deffn
6447 @end deffn
6448
6449 @node General Commands
6450 @chapter General Commands
6451 @cindex commands
6452
6453 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
6454 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
6455 commands are documented elsewhere.
6456
6457 Intent:
6458 @itemize @bullet
6459 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
6460 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
6461 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programatically,
6462 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
6463
6464 @item @b{From the human}
6465 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
6466 or via GDB (default port 3333).
6467
6468 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
6469 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
6470 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
6471
6472 @item @b{Machine Interface}
6473 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
6474 port is 5555.
6475 @end itemize
6476
6477
6478 @section Daemon Commands
6479
6480 @deffn {Command} exit
6481 Exits the current telnet session.
6482 @end deffn
6483
6484 @deffn {Command} help [string]
6485 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
6486 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
6487 Not every command provides helptext.
6488
6489 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
6490 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
6491 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
6492 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
6493 @end deffn
6494
6495 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
6496 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
6497 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
6498 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
6499 Useful in connection with script files
6500 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
6501 @end deffn
6502
6503 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
6504 Close the OpenOCD daemon, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
6505 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
6506 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
6507 @end deffn
6508
6509 @anchor{debuglevel}
6510 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
6511 @cindex message level
6512 Display debug level.
6513 If @var{n} (from 0..3) is provided, then set it to that level.
6514 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
6515 Level 0 is error messages only;
6516 level 1 adds warnings;
6517 level 2 adds informational messages;
6518 and level 3 adds debugging messages.
6519 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
6520 the command line along with the location of that log
6521 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
6522 @xref{Running}.
6523 @end deffn
6524
6525 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
6526 Logs a message at "user" priority.
6527 Output @var{message} to stdout.
6528 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
6529 @example
6530 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
6531 @end example
6532 @end deffn
6533
6534 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
6535 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
6536 the initial log output channel is stderr.
6537 @end deffn
6538
6539 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
6540 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
6541 @end deffn
6542
6543 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
6544 @section Target State handling
6545 @cindex reset
6546 @cindex halt
6547 @cindex target initialization
6548
6549 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
6550 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
6551 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
6552 a current target which is used to perform the
6553 various operations. The current target may be changed
6554 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
6555 target which should become current.
6556
6557 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
6558 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
6559 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
6560 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
6561 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
6562
6563 @emph{With no arguments}:
6564 list all available registers for the current target,
6565 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
6566 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
6567 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
6568 are flagged as such.
6569
6570 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
6571 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
6572 bypassing any internal cache.
6573
6574 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
6575 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
6576 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
6577 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
6578 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
6579 relevant module will flush such values.
6580
6581 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
6582 Debug and trace infrastructure:
6583
6584 @example
6585 > reg
6586 ===== ARM registers
6587 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
6588 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
6589 (2) r2 (/32)
6590 ...
6591 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
6592 >
6593 @end example
6594 @end deffn
6595
6596 @deffn Command halt [ms]
6597 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
6598 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
6599 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
6600 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
6601 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
6602 (and enter debug mode).
6603 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
6604
6605 @quotation Warning
6606 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
6607 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
6608 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
6609 power mode by gating the core clock;
6610 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
6611
6612 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
6613 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
6614 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
6615 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
6616 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
6617 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
6618
6619 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
6620 work with a JTAG debugger.
6621 Tasking environments generaly have idle loops where the body is the
6622 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
6623 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
6624 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
6625 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
6626 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
6627 @end quotation
6628
6629 @end deffn
6630
6631 @deffn Command resume [address]
6632 Resume the target at its current code position,
6633 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6634 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
6635 @end deffn
6636
6637 @deffn Command step [address]
6638 Single-step the target at its current code position,
6639 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6640 @end deffn
6641
6642 @anchor{resetcommand}
6643 @deffn Command reset
6644 @deffnx Command {reset run}
6645 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
6646 @deffnx Command {reset init}
6647 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
6648 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
6649 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
6650
6651 The optional parameter specifies what should
6652 happen after the reset.
6653 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
6654 The other options will not work on all systems.
6655 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
6656
6657 @itemize @minus
6658 @item @b{run} Let the target run
6659 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
6660 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
6661 @end itemize
6662 @end deffn
6663
6664 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
6665 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
6666 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
6667 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
6668 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
6669 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
6670 state.
6671 @end deffn
6672
6673 @section I/O Utilities
6674
6675 These commands are available when
6676 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
6677 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
6678 notably the ZY1000.
6679 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
6680
6681 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
6682
6683 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
6684 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
6685 the text file @file{filename}.
6686 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
6687 The last string is followed by a newline.
6688 @end deffn
6689
6690 @deffn Command cat filename
6691 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
6692 @end deffn
6693
6694 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
6695 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
6696 into @file{dest_filename}.
6697 @end deffn
6698
6699 @deffn Command ip
6700 @emph{No description provided.}
6701 @end deffn
6702
6703 @deffn Command ls
6704 @emph{No description provided.}
6705 @end deffn
6706
6707 @deffn Command mac
6708 @emph{No description provided.}
6709 @end deffn
6710
6711 @deffn Command meminfo
6712 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
6713 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
6714 @end deffn
6715
6716 @deffn Command peek
6717 @emph{No description provided.}
6718 @end deffn
6719
6720 @deffn Command poke
6721 @emph{No description provided.}
6722 @end deffn
6723
6724 @deffn Command rm filename
6725 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
6726 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
6727 @end deffn
6728
6729 @deffn Command trunc filename
6730 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
6731 @end deffn
6732
6733 @anchor{memoryaccess}
6734 @section Memory access commands
6735 @cindex memory access
6736
6737 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
6738 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
6739 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
6740 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
6741
6742 @enumerate
6743 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
6744 to change the current target.
6745 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
6746 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
6747 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
6748 @end enumerate
6749
6750 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
6751 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
6752 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
6753 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
6754 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
6755 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
6756 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6757 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6758 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6759 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6760 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
6761 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
6762 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
6763 @end deffn
6764
6765 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
6766 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
6767 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
6768 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
6769 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
6770 at the specified address @var{addr}.
6771 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6772 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6773 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6774 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6775 @end deffn
6776
6777 @anchor{imageaccess}
6778 @section Image loading commands
6779 @cindex image loading
6780 @cindex image dumping
6781
6782 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
6783 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
6784 binary file named @var{filename}.
6785 @end deffn
6786
6787 @deffn Command {fast_load}
6788 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
6789 current target. Must be preceeded by fast_load_image.
6790 @end deffn
6791
6792 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
6793 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
6794 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
6795 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
6796 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
6797 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
6798 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
6799 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
6800 separately.
6801 @end deffn
6802
6803 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
6804 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
6805 The file format may optionally be specified
6806 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
6807 In addition the following arguments may be specifed:
6808 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
6809 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
6810 @example
6811 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
6812 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
6813 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
6814 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
6815 $address $length
6816 @}
6817 @end example
6818 @end deffn
6819
6820 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
6821 Displays image section sizes and addresses
6822 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
6823 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
6824 The file format may optionally be specified
6825 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
6826 @end deffn
6827
6828 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
6829 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
6830 The file format may optionally be specified
6831 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
6832 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
6833 @end deffn
6834
6835
6836 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
6837 @cindex breakpoint
6838 @cindex watchpoint
6839
6840 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
6841 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
6842 watchpoints.
6843 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
6844
6845 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
6846 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
6847 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
6848 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
6849 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
6850 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
6851
6852 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
6853 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
6854 @end deffn
6855
6856 @deffn Command {rbp} address
6857 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
6858 @end deffn
6859
6860 @deffn Command {rwp} address
6861 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
6862 @end deffn
6863
6864 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
6865 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
6866 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
6867 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
6868 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
6869 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
6870 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
6871 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
6872 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
6873 @end deffn
6874
6875 @section Misc Commands
6876
6877 @cindex profiling
6878 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
6879 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
6880 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
6881 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
6882 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
6883 limit the address range.
6884 @end deffn
6885
6886 @deffn Command {version}
6887 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
6888 @end deffn
6889
6890 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
6891 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
6892 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
6893 @end deffn
6894
6895 @node Architecture and Core Commands
6896 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
6897 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
6898 @cindex Core Specific Commands
6899
6900 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
6901 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
6902 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
6903 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
6904
6905 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
6906 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
6907 @cindex tracing
6908 @cindex ETM
6909 @cindex ETB
6910
6911 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
6912 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
6913 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
6914
6915 @itemize
6916 @item
6917 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
6918 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
6919 supports such an interface.
6920 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
6921 and trace port support.)
6922 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
6923 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
6924 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
6925 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
6926 in the board-specific configuration file.
6927 @item
6928 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
6929 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
6930 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
6931 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
6932 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
6933 @end itemize
6934
6935 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
6936
6937 @quotation Issues
6938 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
6939 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
6940
6941 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
6942 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
6943 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
6944 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
6945 dummy trace port driver}.
6946
6947 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
6948 as well as tracing only during specific states
6949 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
6950
6951 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
6952 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
6953 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
6954 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
6955 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
6956
6957 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
6958 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
6959 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
6960 this original style of JTAG access.
6961 @end quotation
6962
6963 @subsection ETM Configuration
6964 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
6965
6966 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
6967 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
6968 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
6969
6970 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
6971 which are a function of silicon capabilties (exposed later
6972 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
6973 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
6974 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
6975 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
6976 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
6977 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
6978 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
6979
6980 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
6981 or @option{demultiplexed}.
6982 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
6983
6984 @quotation Warning
6985 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
6986 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
6987 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
6988 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
6989 @end quotation
6990
6991 @quotation Note
6992 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
6993 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
6994 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
6995 what CPU activities are traced.
6996 @end quotation
6997 @end deffn
6998
6999 @deffn Command {etm info}
7000 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
7001 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
7002 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
7003 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
7004 @end deffn
7005
7006 @deffn Command {etm status}
7007 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
7008 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
7009 Did trace data overflow?
7010 Was it triggered?
7011 @end deffn
7012
7013 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
7014 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
7015 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
7016 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
7017 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
7018
7019 @itemize
7020 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
7021 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
7022 The value is one of
7023 @option{none} (save nothing),
7024 @option{data} (save data),
7025 @option{address} (save addresses),
7026 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
7027 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
7028 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
7029 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
7030 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
7031 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
7032 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
7033 trace stream without an image of the code.
7034 @end itemize
7035 @end deffn
7036
7037 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7038 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
7039 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
7040 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
7041 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
7042
7043 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
7044 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
7045 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
7046 @end deffn
7047
7048 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
7049
7050 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
7051 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
7052 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
7053
7054 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
7055 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
7056 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
7057 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
7058 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
7059 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
7060 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
7061
7062 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
7063
7064 @itemize
7065 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
7066 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
7067 for instruction access within that function's body.
7068 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
7069 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
7070 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
7071 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
7072 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
7073 combining one of the above models with a counter.
7074 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
7075 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
7076 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
7077 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
7078 @item @emph{... more}
7079 @end itemize
7080
7081 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
7082 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
7083
7084 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
7085 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
7086 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
7087 @end deffn
7088
7089 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
7090 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
7091 @end deffn
7092
7093 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
7094 Opens an image file.
7095 @end deffn
7096
7097 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
7098 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
7099 @end deffn
7100
7101 @deffn Command {etm start}
7102 Starts trace data collection.
7103 @end deffn
7104
7105 @deffn Command {etm stop}
7106 Stops trace data collection.
7107 @end deffn
7108
7109 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
7110 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
7111
7112 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
7113
7114 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
7115 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7116 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
7117 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
7118 any trace data collection.}
7119 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
7120 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
7121 @end deffn
7122 @end deffn
7123
7124 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
7125 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
7126 to use on-chip ETB memory.
7127 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
7128 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
7129 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
7130 @end deffn
7131 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
7132 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
7133 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
7134 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
7135 trace trigger becomes active.
7136
7137 @itemize
7138 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
7139 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
7140 afterwards.
7141 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
7142 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
7143 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
7144 what caused that event to happen.
7145 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
7146 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
7147 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
7148 how the event caused trouble.
7149 @end itemize
7150 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
7151 @end deffn
7152
7153 @end deffn
7154
7155 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
7156 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
7157 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
7158 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
7159 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
7160
7161 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7162 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
7163
7164 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
7165 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
7166 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
7167 @end deffn
7168
7169 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
7170 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
7171 @end deffn
7172
7173 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
7174 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
7175 @end deffn
7176 @end deffn
7177
7178
7179 @section Generic ARM
7180 @cindex ARM
7181
7182 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
7183 They are available in addition to other core-specific
7184 commands that may be available.
7185
7186 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
7187 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
7188 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
7189 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
7190 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7191 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
7192 @end deffn
7193
7194 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
7195 @cindex disassemble
7196 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
7197 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
7198 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
7199 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
7200 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
7201 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7202 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
7203
7204 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
7205 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
7206 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
7207 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
7208 with a handful of exceptions.
7209 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
7210 @end deffn
7211
7212 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
7213 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
7214 passing parameters @var{CRn},
7215 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7216 and using the MCR instruction.
7217 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7218 an ARM register.)
7219 @end deffn
7220
7221 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
7222 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
7223 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7224 and the MRC instruction.
7225 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
7226 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7227 an ARM register.)
7228 @end deffn
7229
7230 @deffn Command {arm reg}
7231 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
7232 core mode if necessary.
7233 @end deffn
7234
7235 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7236 @cindex ARM semihosting
7237 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
7238
7239 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
7240 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
7241 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
7242 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
7243 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
7244 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
7245 @end deffn
7246
7247 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
7248 @cindex ARMv4
7249 @cindex ARMv5
7250
7251 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
7252 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
7253 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
7254 variant.
7255
7256 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
7257 @cindex ARM7
7258 @cindex ARM9
7259
7260 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
7261 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
7262 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
7263 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
7264
7265 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7266 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
7267 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
7268 instead of breakpoints.
7269 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7270
7271 This should be
7272 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
7273 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
7274 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
7275 @end deffn
7276
7277 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7278 @cindex DCC
7279 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
7280 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
7281 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7282
7283 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
7284 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
7285 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
7286 @end deffn
7287
7288 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7289 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
7290 that don't check completion of the operation.
7291 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7292
7293 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
7294 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
7295 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
7296 @end deffn
7297
7298 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
7299 @cindex ARM720T
7300
7301 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
7302 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7303 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
7304 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
7305
7306 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
7307 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7308 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7309
7310 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
7311 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7312 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
7313 @end deffn
7314
7315 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
7316 @cindex ARM9
7317
7318 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
7319 integer processors.
7320 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
7321
7322 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
7323 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
7324 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
7325 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
7326
7327 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
7328 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7329 @cindex vector_catch
7330 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
7331 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
7332 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
7333 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
7334 to those hardware vectors.
7335
7336 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
7337 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
7338 vector catch hardware to intercept
7339 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
7340 @option{none} of them,
7341 or a list with one or more of the following:
7342 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
7343 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
7344 @end deffn
7345
7346 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
7347 @cindex ARM920T
7348
7349 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
7350 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7351 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
7352 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7353 and ARM9 commands.
7354
7355 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
7356 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
7357 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
7358 @end deffn
7359
7360 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
7361 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7362 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7363 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
7364 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
7365 (Not all registers can be written.)
7366 @end deffn
7367
7368 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
7369 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7370 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7371
7372 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
7373 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
7374 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
7375 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
7376 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
7377 or using zero if no other address is provided.
7378 @end deffn
7379
7380 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
7381 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
7382 @end deffn
7383
7384 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
7385 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
7386 @end deffn
7387
7388 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
7389 @cindex ARM926ej-s
7390
7391 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
7392 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
7393 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
7394 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7395 and ARM9 commands.
7396
7397 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
7398 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
7399
7400 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
7401 Print information about the caches found.
7402 @end deffn
7403
7404 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
7405 @cindex ARM966E
7406
7407 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
7408 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7409 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7410 and ARM9 commands.
7411
7412 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
7413 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7414 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7415 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
7416 ARM966E-S TRM.
7417 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
7418 as required for BIST support.
7419 @end deffn
7420
7421 @subsection XScale specific commands
7422 @cindex XScale
7423
7424 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
7425
7426 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
7427 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
7428 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
7429 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
7430 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
7431 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
7432 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
7433
7434 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
7435 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicity write
7436 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
7437 the mini-IC.
7438
7439 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
7440 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
7441 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
7442 code layout in memory:
7443 @example
7444 _vectors:
7445 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7446 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7447 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7448 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7449 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7450 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7451 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7452 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7453 .org 0x100
7454 .long real_reset_vector
7455 .long real_ui_handler
7456 .long real_swi_handler
7457 .long real_pf_abort
7458 .long real_data_abort
7459 .long 0 /* unused */
7460 .long real_irq_handler
7461 .long real_fiq_handler
7462 @end example
7463
7464 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
7465 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
7466 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
7467 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
7468 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
7469 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
7470 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
7471 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
7472 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
7473 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
7474 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
7475 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
7476 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
7477 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
7478 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
7479 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
7480 software.
7481
7482 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
7483 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
7484 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
7485 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
7486
7487 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
7488 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
7489 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
7490 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
7491 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
7492 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
7493 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
7494 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
7495 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
7496
7497 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
7498 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7499
7500 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
7501 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
7502 @end deffn
7503
7504 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
7505 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
7506 @end deffn
7507
7508 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
7509 Displays information about the CPU caches.
7510 @end deffn
7511
7512 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
7513 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7514 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7515 @end deffn
7516
7517 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
7518 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
7519 @end deffn
7520
7521 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7522 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
7523 @end deffn
7524
7525 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
7526 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
7527 @end deffn
7528
7529 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7530 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
7531 @end deffn
7532
7533 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7534 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
7535 @end deffn
7536
7537 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
7538 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
7539 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
7540 and modifying how it is emptied.
7541 @end deffn
7542
7543 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
7544 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
7545 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
7546 The image @var{type} may be one of
7547 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
7548 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
7549 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
7550 @end deffn
7551
7552 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
7553 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
7554 @cindex vector_catch
7555 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
7556 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
7557
7558 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
7559 @example
7560 0x01 Trap Reset
7561 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
7562 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
7563 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
7564 0x10 Trap Data Abort
7565 0x20 reserved
7566 0x40 Trap IRQ
7567 0x80 Trap FIQ
7568 @end example
7569 @end deffn
7570
7571 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
7572 @cindex vector_table
7573
7574 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
7575 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
7576 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
7577 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
7578 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
7579
7580 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
7581
7582 @end deffn
7583
7584 @section ARMv6 Architecture
7585 @cindex ARMv6
7586
7587 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
7588 @cindex ARM11
7589
7590 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7591 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
7592 which is enabled by default.
7593 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7594 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
7595 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
7596 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
7597 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
7598 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
7599 @end deffn
7600
7601 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7602 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
7603 which is enabled by default.
7604 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7605 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
7606 @end deffn
7607
7608 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7609 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
7610 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
7611 they are disabled by default.
7612 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
7613 @end deffn
7614
7615 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
7616 @cindex vector_catch
7617 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
7618 coprocessor 14 register 7.
7619 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7620
7621 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7622 for certain hardware events.
7623 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
7624 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
7625 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
7626 @end deffn
7627
7628 @section ARMv7 Architecture
7629 @cindex ARMv7
7630
7631 @subsection ARMv7 Debug Access Port (DAP) specific commands
7632 @cindex Debug Access Port
7633 @cindex DAP
7634 These commands are specific to ARM architecture v7 Debug Access Port (DAP),
7635 included on Cortex-M and Cortex-A systems.
7636 They are available in addition to other core-specific commands that may be available.
7637
7638 @deffn Command {dap apid} [num]
7639 Displays ID register from AP @var{num},
7640 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7641 @end deffn
7642
7643 @deffn Command {dap apsel} [num]
7644 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
7645 @end deffn
7646
7647 @deffn Command {dap baseaddr} [num]
7648 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
7649 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7650 @end deffn
7651
7652 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
7653 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
7654 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7655 @end deffn
7656
7657 @deffn Command {dap memaccess} [value]
7658 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
7659 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
7660 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7661 @end deffn
7662
7663 @deffn Command {dap apcsw} [0 / 1]
7664 fix CSW_SPROT from register AP_REG_CSW on selected dap.
7665 Defaulting to 0.
7666 @end deffn
7667
7668 @deffn Command {dap ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
7669 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
7670 Disabled by default
7671 @end deffn
7672
7673
7674 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
7675 @cindex Cortex-A
7676
7677 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
7678 display information about target caches
7679 @end deffn
7680
7681 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
7682 Initialize core debug
7683 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
7684 @end deffn
7685
7686 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_off}
7687 Disable SMP mode
7688 @end deffn
7689
7690 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_on}
7691 Enable SMP mode
7692 @end deffn
7693
7694 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
7695 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
7696 @end deffn
7697
7698 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
7699 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
7700 @end deffn
7701
7702 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
7703 configure l2x cache
7704 @end deffn
7705
7706
7707 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
7708 @cindex Cortex-R
7709
7710 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
7711 Initialize core debug
7712 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
7713 @end deffn
7714
7715 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
7716 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
7717 @end deffn
7718
7719
7720 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
7721 @cindex tracing
7722 @cindex SWO
7723 @cindex SWV
7724 @cindex TPIU
7725 @cindex ITM
7726 @cindex ETM
7727
7728 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
7729 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
7730 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
7731
7732 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
7733 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
7734 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
7735 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
7736
7737 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
7738 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
7739 debugger adapter features.
7740
7741 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
7742 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
7743
7744 Command options:
7745 @itemize @minus
7746 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
7747 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
7748 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
7749 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
7750 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
7751 either a regular file or a named pipe);
7752 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
7753 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
7754 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
7755 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
7756 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
7757 coding;
7758 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
7759 regular UART 8N1) coding;
7760 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
7761 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
7762 data is to be output via SWO;
7763 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
7764 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
7765 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
7766 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
7767 rate automatically.
7768 @end itemize
7769
7770 Example usage:
7771 @enumerate
7772 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
7773 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
7774 enough to:
7775 @example
7776 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
7777 ...
7778 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
7779 ...
7780 @end example
7781 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
7782 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
7783 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
7784 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
7785 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
7786 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
7787 @example
7788 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
7789 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
7790 @end example
7791 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
7792 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
7793 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
7794 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
7795 @example
7796 openocd -f interface/stlink-v2-1.cfg \
7797 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
7798 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
7799 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
7800 @end example
7801 @end enumerate
7802 @end deffn
7803
7804 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7805 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
7806 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
7807 @end deffn
7808
7809 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7810 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
7811 @end deffn
7812
7813 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
7814 @cindex Cortex-M
7815
7816 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7817 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
7818
7819 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping a way they get
7820 served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
7821 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
7822 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
7823 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
7824 the step command leaves with the core running.
7825
7826 Note that a free breakpoint is required for the @option{auto} option. If no
7827 breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step is taken
7828 with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option does.
7829
7830 Default is @option{auto}.
7831 @end deffn
7832
7833 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7834 @cindex vector_catch
7835 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7836 for certain hardware events.
7837
7838 Parameters request interception of
7839 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
7840 @option{none} of them,
7841 or one or more of the following:
7842 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
7843 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
7844 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
7845 @option{irq_err},
7846 @option{state_err},
7847 @option{chk_err}, or
7848 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
7849 @option{reset}.
7850 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
7851 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
7852 are mapped to HardFault.
7853 UsageFault checks for
7854 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
7855 must also be explicitly enabled.
7856
7857 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
7858 @end deffn
7859
7860 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{srst}|@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
7861 Control reset handling. The default @option{srst} is to use srst if fitted,
7862 otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
7863 @itemize @minus
7864 @item @option{srst} use hardware srst if fitted otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
7865 @item @option{sysresetreq} use NVIC SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
7866 @item @option{vectreset} use NVIC VECTRESET to reset system.
7867 @end itemize
7868 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for all current Cortex-M cores.
7869 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
7870 are uneffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler to manually reset
7871 the peripherals.
7872 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
7873 @end deffn
7874
7875 @section Intel Architecture
7876
7877 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
7878 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
7879 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
7880 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
7881 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
7882 @itemize
7883 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
7884 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
7885 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
7886 @end itemize
7887
7888 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
7889 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
7890 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
7891
7892 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
7893 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7894 @end deffn
7895
7896 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
7897 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7898 @end deffn
7899
7900 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
7901 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7902 @end deffn
7903
7904 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
7905 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7906 @end deffn
7907
7908 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
7909 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7910 @end deffn
7911
7912 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
7913 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7914 @end deffn
7915
7916 @section OpenRISC Architecture
7917
7918 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
7919 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
7920
7921 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
7922 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
7923 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
7924 @end deffn
7925 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
7926 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
7927
7928 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
7929
7930 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
7931 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
7932 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
7933 @end deffn
7934
7935 @subsection Registers commands
7936 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
7937 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
7938 included in the generated target descriptor file.
7939
7940 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
7941
7942 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
7943 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
7944 and "timer" groups.
7945
7946 @emph{example:}
7947 @example
7948 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
7949 @end example
7950
7951
7952 @end deffn
7953 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
7954 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
7955
7956 @emph{group} can be "system",
7957 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
7958 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
7959 @end deffn
7960
7961 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
7962 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
7963 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
7964 @cindex tracing
7965 @cindex libdcc
7966 @cindex DCC
7967 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
7968 the target uses appropriate libraries.
7969 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
7970 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
7971
7972 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
7973 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
7974 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
7975 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
7976 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
7977 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
7978
7979 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
7980 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
7981 arrays of various size integers from the target,
7982 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
7983 The target being debugged may
7984 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
7985 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
7986 each supported by a command:
7987
7988 @itemize
7989 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
7990 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
7991 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
7992 finding out how some fault was triggered.
7993
7994 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
7995 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
7996 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
7997
7998 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
7999 and then displayed at any time.
8000 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
8001
8002 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
8003 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
8004 @end itemize
8005
8006 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
8007 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
8008 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
8009 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
8010 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
8011 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
8012 does the same thing.
8013
8014 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
8015 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
8016 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
8017 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
8018 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
8019
8020 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
8021 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
8022 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
8023 @end deffn
8024
8025 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
8026 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
8027 in the order they triggered.
8028 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
8029 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
8030 history records.
8031 @end deffn
8032
8033 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
8034 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
8035 they have been triggered.
8036 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
8037 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
8038 and associates it with that identifier.
8039
8040 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
8041 are not related except by this command.
8042 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
8043 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
8044 @end deffn
8045
8046
8047 @node JTAG Commands
8048 @chapter JTAG Commands
8049 @cindex JTAG Commands
8050 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
8051 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
8052 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
8053 may be needed to work with targets which require special
8054 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
8055
8056 To use these commands you will need to understand some
8057 of the basics of JTAG, including:
8058
8059 @itemize @bullet
8060 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
8061 devices such as a CPUs.
8062 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
8063 standard state machine (in parallel)
8064 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
8065 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
8066 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
8067 while the reading previous ones.
8068 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
8069 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
8070 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
8071 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
8072 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
8073 registers.
8074 @end itemize
8075
8076 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
8077
8078 These commands are used by developers who need to access
8079 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
8080 the order of TAP state transitions.
8081 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
8082 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
8083 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
8084 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
8085 these commands are not available.
8086
8087 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8088 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
8089 that specify the entire register.
8090 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
8091 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
8092 The return value holds the original value of each
8093 of those fields.
8094
8095 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
8096 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
8097 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
8098 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
8099 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
8100
8101 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
8102 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
8103
8104 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8105 in that state.
8106 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
8107 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8108 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8109
8110 @quotation Warning
8111 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
8112 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
8113 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
8114 data registers, which may have different lengths.
8115 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
8116 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
8117 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
8118 (by connecting a different scan chain).
8119 @end quotation
8120 @end deffn
8121
8122 @deffn Command {flush_count}
8123 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
8124 This may be used for performance tuning.
8125
8126 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
8127 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
8128 not change with the amount of data which is written.
8129 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
8130 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
8131 instead of batching them into larger operations.
8132 @end deffn
8133
8134 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8135 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
8136 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
8137 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
8138 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
8139 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
8140
8141 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8142 in that state.
8143 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
8144 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8145 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8146
8147 @quotation Note
8148 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
8149 register values, unlike data register values.
8150 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
8151 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
8152 @end quotation
8153 @end deffn
8154
8155 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
8156 Set values of reset signals.
8157 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
8158 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
8159 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
8160 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8161 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
8162 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8163 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8164
8165 Note that TRST is specially handled.
8166 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8167 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8168 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8169 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8170 instead of the TRST signal.
8171 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8172 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8173 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8174 with handlers for that event.
8175 @end deffn
8176
8177 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
8178 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
8179 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
8180 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
8181 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
8182 Then, in a series of single state transitions
8183 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
8184 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
8185 The final state must also be stable.
8186 @end deffn
8187
8188 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
8189 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
8190 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
8191 Instructions often need some time
8192 to execute before they take effect.
8193 @end deffn
8194
8195 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
8196 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
8197
8198 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8199 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
8200 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
8201 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
8202 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
8203 @end deffn
8204
8205 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8206 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
8207 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
8208 must also be enabled.
8209 Default is enabled.
8210 @end deffn
8211
8212 @section TAP state names
8213 @cindex TAP state names
8214
8215 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
8216 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
8217 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
8218 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
8219
8220 @itemize @bullet
8221 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
8222 acts as if TRST were pulsed
8223 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
8224 @item @b{DRSELECT}
8225 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
8226 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8227 through the data register
8228 @item @b{DREXIT1}
8229 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
8230 for update or more shifting
8231 @item @b{DREXIT2}
8232 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
8233 @item @b{IRSELECT}
8234 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
8235 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8236 through the instruction register
8237 @item @b{IREXIT1}
8238 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
8239 for update or more shifting
8240 @item @b{IREXIT2}
8241 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
8242 @end itemize
8243
8244 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
8245 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
8246 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
8247 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
8248
8249 @itemize @bullet
8250 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
8251 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
8252 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
8253 may not be as expected.
8254 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
8255 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
8256 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
8257 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
8258 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
8259 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
8260 @end itemize
8261
8262 @node Boundary Scan Commands
8263 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
8264
8265 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
8266 boundary scan based hardware testing.
8267 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
8268 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
8269
8270 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
8271 @cindex Serial Vector Format
8272 @cindex SVF
8273
8274 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
8275 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
8276 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8277 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8278
8279 @deffn Command {svf} filename [@option{quiet}]
8280 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8281 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
8282 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8283 each command is logged before it is executed.
8284 @end deffn
8285
8286 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8287 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8288 @cindex XSVF
8289
8290 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
8291 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
8292 Xilinx devices.
8293 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8294 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8295
8296 @quotation Important
8297 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
8298 @end quotation
8299
8300 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
8301 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8302 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
8303 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
8304 that TAP.
8305 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
8306 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
8307 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8308 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
8309 @end deffn
8310
8311 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
8312 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
8313 after building the software.
8314 You may find them useful:
8315
8316 @itemize
8317 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
8318 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
8319 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
8320 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
8321 @end itemize
8322
8323 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
8324 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
8325 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
8326 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
8327 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
8328 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
8329 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
8330
8331
8332 @node Utility Commands
8333 @chapter Utility Commands
8334 @cindex Utility Commands
8335
8336 @section RAM testing
8337 @cindex RAM testing
8338
8339 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
8340 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
8341 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
8342 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
8343 hardware problems.
8344
8345 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
8346 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
8347 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
8348 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
8349
8350 Load the memory testing functions with
8351
8352 @example
8353 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
8354 @end example
8355
8356 to get access to the following facilities:
8357
8358 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
8359 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
8360 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
8361 @end deffn
8362
8363 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
8364 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
8365 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
8366 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
8367 @end deffn
8368
8369 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
8370 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
8371 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
8372 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
8373 @end deffn
8374
8375 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
8376 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
8377 @end deffn
8378
8379 @section Firmware recovery helpers
8380 @cindex Firmware recovery
8381
8382 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
8383 devices recovery with JTAG.
8384
8385 For quickstart instructions run:
8386 @example
8387 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
8388 @end example
8389
8390 @node TFTP
8391 @chapter TFTP
8392 @cindex TFTP
8393 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
8394 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
8395
8396 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
8397 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
8398 server (tftpd). For example,
8399
8400 @example
8401 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
8402 @end example
8403
8404 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
8405 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
8406
8407 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
8408 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
8409 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
8410 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
8411
8412 @node GDB and OpenOCD
8413 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
8414 @cindex GDB
8415 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
8416 to debug remote targets.
8417 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
8418
8419 @itemize
8420 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
8421 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
8422 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
8423 as shown in this chapter.
8424 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
8425 that also will probably need to be configured.
8426 @end itemize
8427
8428 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
8429 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
8430 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
8431 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
8432 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
8433 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
8434
8435 @section Connecting to GDB
8436 @cindex Connecting to GDB
8437 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
8438 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
8439 errors, which has since been fixed; see
8440 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
8441
8442 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
8443
8444 @enumerate
8445 @item
8446 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
8447 @example
8448 target remote localhost:3333
8449 @end example
8450 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
8451
8452 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
8453 @example
8454 target extended-remote localhost:3333
8455 @end example
8456 @item
8457 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
8458 @example
8459 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
8460 @end example
8461 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
8462 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
8463 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
8464 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
8465 @end enumerate
8466
8467 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
8468 GDB command line.
8469
8470 @section Sample GDB session startup
8471
8472 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
8473 than they do when you're debugging locally.
8474 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
8475 small ARM program.
8476 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
8477 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
8478
8479 @example
8480 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
8481 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
8482 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
8483 ...
8484 (gdb) monitor reset halt
8485 ...
8486 (gdb) load
8487 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
8488 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
8489 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
8490 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
8491 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
8492 (gdb) continue
8493 Continuing.
8494 ...
8495 @end example
8496
8497 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
8498 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
8499 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
8500 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
8501
8502 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
8503
8504 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
8505 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
8506 packet size and the device's memory map.
8507 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
8508 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
8509 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
8510
8511 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
8512 You may need to set those up by hand.
8513 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
8514 something like:
8515
8516 @example
8517 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
8518 @end example
8519
8520 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
8521
8522 @example
8523 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
8524 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
8525 @end example
8526
8527 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
8528 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
8529 do not have such restrictions.
8530
8531 Another example of useful GDB configuration came from a user who
8532 found that single stepping his Cortex-M3 didn't work well with IRQs
8533 and an RTOS until he told GDB to disable the IRQs while stepping:
8534
8535 @example
8536 define hook-step
8537 mon cortex_m maskisr on
8538 end
8539 define hookpost-step
8540 mon cortex_m maskisr off
8541 end
8542 @end example
8543
8544 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
8545 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
8546 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
8547 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
8548
8549 @section Programming using GDB
8550 @cindex Programming using GDB
8551 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
8552
8553 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
8554 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
8555 @example
8556 gdb_memory_map disable
8557 @end example
8558 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
8559 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
8560 working area.
8561
8562 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
8563 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
8564 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
8565 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
8566
8567 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
8568 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
8569
8570 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
8571 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
8572 @example
8573 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
8574 @end example
8575
8576 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
8577 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
8578
8579 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
8580 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
8581 will be used.
8582
8583 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, an event
8584 script can be executed:
8585 @example
8586 $_TARGETNAME configure -event EVENTNAME BODY
8587 @end example
8588
8589 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
8590 can be used.
8591 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
8592 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
8593 @cindex SMP
8594 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
8595 @itemize @bullet
8596 @item j - smp status request
8597 @item J - smp set request
8598 @end itemize
8599
8600 OpenOCD implements :
8601 @itemize @bullet
8602 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
8603 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
8604 @option{E01} for target not smp.
8605 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
8606 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
8607 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
8608 @end itemize
8609
8610 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
8611 @itemize @bullet
8612 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
8613 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
8614 @example
8615 set $_core 1
8616 #Jc01 packet is sent
8617 print $_core
8618 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
8619 @end example
8620
8621 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
8622 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
8623
8624 @example
8625 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
8626 define toggle0
8627 maint packet Jc0
8628 continue
8629 main packet Jc-1
8630 end
8631 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
8632 define toggle1
8633 maint packet Jc1
8634 continue
8635 main packet Jc-1
8636 end
8637 @end example
8638 @end itemize
8639
8640 @section RTOS Support
8641 @cindex RTOS Support
8642 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
8643
8644 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
8645 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
8646
8647 @* An example setup is below:
8648
8649 @example
8650 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
8651 @end example
8652
8653 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
8654
8655 Currently supported rtos's include:
8656 @itemize @bullet
8657 @item @option{eCos}
8658 @item @option{ThreadX}
8659 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
8660 @item @option{linux}
8661 @item @option{ChibiOS}
8662 @item @option{embKernel}
8663 @item @option{mqx}
8664 @end itemize
8665
8666 @quotation Note
8667 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
8668 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
8669 @end quotation
8670
8671 @table @code
8672 @item eCos symbols
8673 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
8674 @item ThreadX symbols
8675 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
8676 @item FreeRTOS symbols
8677 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
8678 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
8679 @tex
8680 \begingroup
8681 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
8682 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
8683 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
8684 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
8685 \par
8686 \endgroup
8687 @end tex
8688 @item linux symbols
8689 init_task.
8690 @item ChibiOS symbols
8691 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
8692 @item embKernel symbols
8693 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
8694 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
8695 @item mqx symbols
8696 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
8697 @end table
8698
8699 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
8700 some, eg. FreeRTOS, extra steps must be taken.
8701
8702 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
8703 along with the project:
8704
8705 @table @code
8706 @item FreeRTOS
8707 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
8708 @end table
8709
8710 @node Tcl Scripting API
8711 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
8712 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
8713 @cindex Tcl scripts
8714 @section API rules
8715
8716 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
8717 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
8718 of state information as an argument to each proc.
8719
8720 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
8721 pair list and lists.
8722
8723 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
8724 list.
8725
8726 @example
8727 > set foo(me) Duane
8728 > set foo(you) Oyvind
8729 > set foo(mouse) Micky
8730 > set foo(duck) Donald
8731 @end example
8732
8733 If one does this:
8734
8735 @example
8736 > set foo
8737 @end example
8738
8739 The result is:
8740
8741 @example
8742 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
8743 @end example
8744
8745 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
8746
8747 @verbatim
8748 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
8749 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
8750 }
8751 @end verbatim
8752
8753 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
8754 should be passed in to the proc in question.
8755
8756 @section Internal low-level Commands
8757
8758 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
8759 invoke directly.
8760
8761 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
8762 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
8763 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
8764
8765 @itemize @bullet
8766 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8767
8768 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
8769 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8770
8771 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
8772 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
8773
8774 Return information about the flash banks
8775
8776 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
8777
8778 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
8779 its execution. Example:
8780
8781 @example
8782 > capture "reset init"
8783 @end example
8784
8785 @end itemize
8786
8787 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
8788 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
8789 called "flash_banks".
8790
8791 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
8792
8793 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
8794 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
8795 holds one of the following values:
8796
8797 @itemize @bullet
8798 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
8799 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating sytem.
8800 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
8801 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
8802 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
8803 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating sytem
8804 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
8805 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
8806 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
8807 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
8808 @end itemize
8809
8810 Note: 'winxx' was choosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
8811
8812 @quotation Note
8813 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
8814 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
8815 @code{jim_platform} (because it
8816 is jim, not real tcl).
8817 @end quotation
8818
8819 @section Tcl RPC server
8820 @cindex RPC
8821
8822 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
8823 commands and receive the results.
8824
8825 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
8826 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
8827 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
8828 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
8829 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
8830
8831 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
8832 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
8833 @command{capture} command.
8834
8835 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
8836
8837 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
8838 @cindex RPC Notifications
8839
8840 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
8841 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
8842
8843 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
8844 in the following format.
8845
8846 @verbatim
8847 type target_event event [event-name]
8848 type target_state state [state-name]
8849 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
8850 @end verbatim
8851
8852 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
8853 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
8854 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
8855 Defaults to off.
8856
8857 @end deffn
8858
8859 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
8860 @cindex RPC trace output
8861
8862 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
8863 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
8864
8865 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
8866
8867 @verbatim
8868 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
8869 @end verbatim
8870
8871 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
8872 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
8873 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
8874 Defaults to off.
8875
8876 See an example application here:
8877 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
8878
8879 @end deffn
8880
8881 @node FAQ
8882 @chapter FAQ
8883 @cindex faq
8884 @enumerate
8885 @anchor{faqrtck}
8886 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
8887 @cindex RTCK
8888 @cindex adaptive clocking
8889 @*
8890
8891 In digital circuit design it is often refered to as ``clock
8892 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
8893 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
8894 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
8895
8896 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
8897 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
8898 for example. There are 2 basic options:
8899 @enumerate
8900 @item
8901 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
8902 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
8903 @item
8904 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
8905 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
8906 @end enumerate
8907
8908 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
8909 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
8910 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
8911 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
8912 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
8913 power).
8914
8915 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
8916 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
8917 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
8918 ARM926 scenario).
8919 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
8920 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
8921 JTAG can use a faster clock.
8922
8923 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
8924 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
8925 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
8926 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
8927
8928 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
8929
8930 In order to make use of this,
8931 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
8932 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
8933
8934 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
8935 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
8936 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
8937 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
8938 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
8939
8940 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
8941 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
8942 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
8943 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
8944
8945 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
8946 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
8947 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
8948 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
8949 with a CPLD.
8950 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
8951 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
8952 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
8953 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
8954 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
8955 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
8956
8957 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
8958
8959 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
8960
8961 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
8962 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
8963 depending on the chips on your board.
8964 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
8965 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
8966 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
8967
8968 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
8969 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
8970 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
8971
8972 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
8973 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
8974 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
8975 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
8976
8977 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
8978 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
8979 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
8980 this way.
8981
8982 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
8983 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
8984 clock rate.
8985 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
8986 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
8987 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8988
8989 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
8990
8991 @example
8992 # Example: 1.234MHz
8993 adapter_khz 1234
8994 @end example
8995
8996
8997 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
8998
8999 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
9000 around Windows filenames.
9001
9002 @example
9003 > echo \a
9004
9005 > echo @{\a@}
9006 \a
9007 > echo "\a"
9008
9009 >
9010 @end example
9011
9012
9013 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
9014
9015 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
9016 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
9017 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
9018
9019 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a frontend like Insight or
9020 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
9021 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
9022
9023 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
9024 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
9025 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
9026
9027 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
9028
9029 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
9030 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
9031 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
9032 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
9033
9034 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
9035 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
9036 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
9037
9038 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
9039 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
9040
9041 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
9042 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
9043 memory read caused data abort".
9044
9045 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
9046 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
9047 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
9048 be done, feel free to add this here.
9049
9050 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
9051 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
9052 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
9053 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
9054 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
9055 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
9056 gracefully stops.
9057
9058 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
9059 your C code, do the same - artifically push some zeros onto the stack,
9060 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
9061
9062 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
9063 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
9064 bytes. Painful...
9065
9066
9067 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
9068 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
9069
9070 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
9071 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
9072 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
9073 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
9074 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
9075 reset, everything else should work fine.
9076
9077 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
9078 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
9079 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
9080 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
9081
9082 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
9083 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
9084 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
9085 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
9086
9087 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
9088
9089 @item @b{USB Power} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the
9090 following error messages: "Error: ft2232.c:201 ft2232_read(): FT_Read returned:
9091 4" and "Error: ft2232.c:365 ft2232_send_and_recv(): couldn't read from FT2232".
9092 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
9093
9094 First of all, the reason might be the USB power supply. Try using a self-powered
9095 hub instead of a direct connection to your computer. Secondly, the error code 4
9096 corresponds to an FT_IO_ERROR, which means that the driver for the FTDI USB
9097 chip ran into some sort of error - this points us to a USB problem.
9098
9099 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
9100 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
9101 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
9102
9103 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
9104 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
9105
9106 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
9107 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
9108 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
9109 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
9110 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
9111 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
9112 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
9113 clock frequency?
9114
9115 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
9116 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
9117 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
9118 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
9119 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
9120
9121 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
9122
9123 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
9124 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
9125 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
9126 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
9127 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
9128 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
9129 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
9130
9131 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
9132
9133 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
9134 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
9135 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
9136 up DRAM and loading it with code.
9137
9138 @anchor{faqtaporder}
9139 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
9140 particular order?
9141
9142 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
9143 the same order used by the hardware.
9144
9145 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example: ST
9146 Microsystems STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
9147 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
9148 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
9149 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
9150 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
9151
9152 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
9153 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
9154 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
9155 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
9156
9157 @itemize @bullet
9158 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
9159 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
9160 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
9161 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
9162 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
9163 @end itemize
9164
9165 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
9166
9167 @itemize @bullet
9168 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
9169 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
9170 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
9171 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
9172 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
9173 @end itemize
9174
9175
9176 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
9177 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
9178 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
9179
9180 TODO.
9181
9182 @end enumerate
9183
9184 @node Tcl Crash Course
9185 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
9186 @cindex Tcl
9187
9188 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
9189 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
9190 how the Tcl scripts work.
9191
9192 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
9193 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
9194 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
9195 OpenOCD.
9196
9197 @section Tcl Rule #1
9198 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
9199 @enumerate
9200 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
9201 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9202 @end enumerate
9203
9204 The Tcl equal is this:
9205
9206 @enumerate
9207 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
9208 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9209 @end enumerate
9210
9211 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
9212 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
9213
9214 @section Tcl Rule #1b
9215 There is a second pair of rules.
9216 @enumerate
9217 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
9218 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
9219 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
9220 in Tcl.
9221 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9222 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
9223 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
9224 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
9225 @end enumerate
9226
9227 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
9228 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
9229 deliberatly. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
9230 Everything is a string}
9231
9232 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
9233 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
9234 difference is subtle.
9235 @enumerate
9236 @item Parse Time
9237 @item Evaluation Time
9238 @end enumerate
9239
9240 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
9241 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
9242 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
9243
9244 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
9245 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
9246 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC langauge ``let x
9247 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
9248
9249 @itemize @bullet
9250 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
9251 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
9252 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
9253 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
9254 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
9255 @example
9256 # bash example
9257 X=`date`
9258 echo "The Date is: $X"
9259 # Tcl example
9260 set X [date]
9261 puts "The Date is: $X"
9262 @end example
9263 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
9264 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
9265 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
9266 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
9267 is a string}
9268 @example
9269 set x "Dinner"
9270 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
9271 @end example
9272 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
9273 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
9274 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
9275 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
9276 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
9277 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
9278 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
9279 @end itemize
9280
9281 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
9282
9283 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
9284
9285 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
9286
9287 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
9288 the normal way.
9289
9290 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
9291 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
9292 line is immedatly executed.
9293
9294 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
9295 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
9296
9297 @subsection Command Execution
9298
9299 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
9300 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
9301 control flow operators.
9302
9303 Commands are executed like this:
9304
9305 @enumerate
9306 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
9307 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
9308 @item Repeat until End Of File.
9309 @end enumerate
9310
9311 It sort of works like this:
9312 @example
9313 for(;;)@{
9314 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
9315
9316 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
9317
9318 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
9319 @}
9320 @end example
9321
9322 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
9323 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
9324 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
9325 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
9326 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
9327 ``LookupCommand()''
9328
9329 @subsection The FOR command
9330
9331 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
9332 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
9333 command just like any other command.
9334
9335 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
9336 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
9337 are:
9338
9339 @enumerate 0
9340 @item The ascii text 'for'
9341 @item The start text
9342 @item The test expression
9343 @item The next text
9344 @item The body text
9345 @end enumerate
9346
9347 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
9348 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
9349 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
9350 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
9351
9352 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
9353 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
9354
9355 @example
9356 int
9357 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
9358 int *argc,
9359 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
9360 @end example
9361
9362 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
9363 introduced a byte-code parser and intepreter, but at the core, it
9364 still operates in the same basic way.
9365
9366 @subsection FOR command implementation
9367
9368 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
9369 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
9370
9371 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
9372
9373 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
9374
9375 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
9376 string. Commands can be seperated by semicolons, or newlines. While
9377 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
9378
9379 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
9380 expression and returns a value.
9381
9382 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
9383 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
9384 @example
9385 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
9386
9387 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
9388
9389 int
9390 MyForCommand( void *interp,
9391 int argc,
9392 char **argv )
9393 @{
9394 if( argc != 5 )@{
9395 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
9396 return ERROR;
9397 @}
9398
9399 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
9400
9401 // Execute the start statement.
9402 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
9403
9404 // Top of loop test
9405 for(;;)@{
9406 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
9407 if( i == 0 )
9408 break;
9409
9410 // Execute the body
9411 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
9412
9413 // Execute the LOOP part
9414 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
9415 @}
9416
9417 // Return no error
9418 SetResult( interp, "" );
9419 return SUCCESS;
9420 @}
9421 @end example
9422
9423 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
9424 in the same basic way.
9425
9426 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
9427
9428 @subsection source and find commands
9429 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
9430 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
9431 @*Remember the parsing rules
9432 @enumerate
9433 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
9434 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
9435 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
9436 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
9437 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
9438 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
9439 That character begins Tcl comments.)
9440 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
9441 it reads a file and executes as a script.
9442 @end enumerate
9443 @subsection format command
9444 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
9445 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
9446 @b{sprintf()}.
9447 @b{Example}
9448 @example
9449 set x 6
9450 set y 7
9451 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
9452 @end example
9453 @enumerate
9454 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
9455 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
9456 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
9457 @* Refer to Rule #1
9458 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
9459 @* Refer to Rule #1.
9460 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
9461 @end enumerate
9462 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
9463 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
9464 @example
9465 #1 Good
9466 proc someproc @{@} @{
9467 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
9468 @}
9469 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
9470 #2 Good - no variables
9471 $_TARGETNAME confgure -event foo "this ; that;"
9472 #3 Good Curly Braces
9473 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
9474 puts "Time: [date]"
9475 @}
9476 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
9477 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
9478 @end example
9479 @enumerate
9480 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
9481 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
9482 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
9483 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
9484 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
9485 command.
9486 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
9487 @*There are 4 examples:
9488 @enumerate
9489 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
9490 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands seperated by semicolons
9491 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
9492 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
9493 @end enumerate
9494
9495 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
9496 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
9497 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
9498
9499 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
9500 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
9501 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
9502 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
9503 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
9504 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
9505 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
9506 @end enumerate
9507 @subsection Global Variables
9508 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
9509 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
9510 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
9511 @example
9512 proc myproc @{ @} @{
9513 set y 0 #Local variable Y
9514 global x #Global variable X
9515 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
9516 @}
9517 @end example
9518 @section Other Tcl Hacks
9519 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
9520 @example
9521 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
9522 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
9523 # Create var name
9524 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
9525 # Make it a global
9526 global $vn
9527 # Set it.
9528 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
9529 @}
9530 @end example
9531 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
9532 @example
9533 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
9534 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
9535 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
9536 @}
9537 @end example
9538
9539 @include fdl.texi
9540
9541 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
9542 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
9543 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
9544 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
9545 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
9546 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
9547
9548 @printindex cp
9549
9550 @node Command and Driver Index
9551 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
9552 @printindex fn
9553
9554 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)